PUB. DIE-0426-000
Digital Cinema Camera
Instruction Manual
The warranty information for Australia and New Zealand is at the end of this Instruction Manual.
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an
equilateral triangle, is intended to alert the user to
the presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage”
within the product’s enclosure, that may be of
sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric
shock to persons.
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
CAUTION:
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC
SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR
BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE
PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO
QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
The exclamation point, within an equilateral triangle, is
intended to alert the user to the presence of important
operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in
the literature accompanying the product.
3
European Union (and EEA) only.
These symbols indicate that this product is not to be disposed of with your household
waste, according to the WEEE Directive (2002/96/EC), the Battery Directive (2006/66/EC)
and/or your national laws implementing those Directives.
This product should be handed over to a designated collection point, e.g., on an authorized
one-for-one basis when you buy a new similar product or to an authorized collection site for recycling waste
electrical and electronic equipment (EEE) and batteries and accumulators. Improper handling of this type of
waste could have a possible impact on the environment and human health due to potentially hazardous
substances that are generally associated with EEE. Your cooperation in the correct disposal of this product
will contribute to the effective usage of natural resources.
For more information about the recycling of this product, please contact your local city office, waste
authority, approved scheme or your household waste disposal service or visit www.canon-europe.com/
environment.
(EEA: Norway, Iceland and Liechtenstein)
Important Safety Instructions
In these safety instructions the word “apparatus”
refers to the Canon Digital Cinema Camera
EOS C500 / EOS C500 PL and all its accessories.
A grounding type plug has two blades and a third
grounding prong. The wide blade or the third
prong are provided for your safety. If the provided
plug does not fit into your outlet, consult an
electrician for replacement of the obsolete outlet.
4
1. Read these instructions.
2. Keep these instructions.
3. Heed all warnings.
10. Protect the power cord from being walked on or
pinched particularly at plugs, convenience
receptacles, and the point where they exit from
the apparatus.
4. Follow all instructions.
5. Do not use this apparatus near water.
6. Clean only with dry cloth.
11. Only use attachments/accessories specified by
the manufacturer.
7. Do not block any ventilation openings. Install in
accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions.
12. Unplug this apparatus during lightning storms or
when unused for long periods of time.
8. Do not install near any heat sources such as
radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other
apparatus (including amplifiers) that produce
heat.
13. Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel.
Servicing is required when the apparatus has
been damaged in any way, such as power-supply
cord or plug is damaged, liquid has been spilled
or objects have fallen into the apparatus, the
apparatus has been exposed to rain or moisture,
does not operate normally, or has been dropped.
9. Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized
or grounding-type plug. A polarized plug has two
blades with one wider than the other.
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canan ICES-003.
Trademark Acknowledgements
• SD and SDHC Logos are trademarks of SD-3C, LLC.
• CompactFlash is a trademark of SanDisk Corporation.
• The Logo is a trademark of CompactFlash Association.
• Microsoft and Windows are trademarks or registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United
States and/or other countries.
• Apple, Mac OS, Final Cut Pro are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
• Avid, Media Composer and NewsCutter are trademarks or registered trademarks of Avid Technology, Inc. or
its subsidiaries in the United States and/or other countries.
• Wi-Fi is a registered trademark of the Wi-Fi Alliance.
• AJA, KONA 3G-SDI are trademarks of AJA Video, Inc. All other trademarks are the property of their
respective holders.
• NVIDIA, GeForce and Quadro are trademarks and/or registered trademarks of NVIDIA Corporation in the U.S.
and other countries.
• HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered trademarks of
HDMI Licensing LLC in the United States and other countries.
• Other names and products not mentioned above may be trademarks or registered trademarks of their
respective companies.
• This device incorporates exFAT technology licensed from Microsoft.
• ANY USE OF THIS PRODUCT OTHER THAN CONSUMER PERSONAL USE IN ANY MANNER THAT
COMPLIES WITH THE MPEG-2 STANDARD FOR ENCODING VIDEO INFORMATION FOR PACKAGED
MEDIA IS EXPRESSLY PROHIBITED WITHOUT A LICENSE UNDER APPLICABLE PATENTS IN THE MPEG-2
PATENT PORTFOLIO, WHICH LICENSE IS AVAILABLE FROM MPEG LA, L.L.C., 250 STEELE STREET,
SUITE 300, DENVER, COLORADO 80206.
Highlights of the EOS C500/C500 PL
The Canon Digital Cinema Camera EOS C500/C500 PL has been designed with the discerning professional in
mind. It is truly a cinematographer’s camera. The following are just some of the many features that will help turn
your creative vision into reality.
5
mode, you can select the system frequency, bit rate,
resolution and frame rate of your recordings. These
options allow you to choose from a total of 27
different combinations.
4K Recording System with Cinema Quality
Advanced 4K-compatible Super 35mm CMOS
sensor
The camera is equipped with a Super 35mm CMOS
sensor that captures video at an effective pixel count
of 8.85 megapixels (4096x2160) and offers a center
resolution of 1,800 TV lines*. Furthermore, thanks to
Canon’s high-sensitivity and low-noise technology,
the camera can record at ISO levels up to 20,000 - a
level of sensitivity that must be seen to be believed!
* Varies depending on the lens used.
Recording media
Because there are two CF card slots, when one CF
card slot becomes full, the recording will
automatically continue on the other one without
you record the same clip simultaneously to both CF
cards.
Interchangeable lenses
Enjoy the freedom of using interchangeable lenses
to achieve exactly the look you want. The EOS C500
features an EF lens mount allowing you to use over
60 high-quality lenses from the Canon Cine Lens
series and EF Lens series. The EOS C500 PL
features a PL lens mount, allowing you to use a vast
array of cinematography lenses compatible with a
Canon PL lens mount and other lenses commonly
used in motion picture production.
3G-SDI and MON. terminals
that can output 4K or 2K image data to an external
HDSDI terminals that can output YCC 4:2:2 10-bit
2K or full HD video, allowing external live monitoring
during shoots using an external monitor with SDI
input. Of course, both sets of terminals also output
audio, SMPTE time code (LTC) and user bit signals.
4K, 2K and MXF modes
Canon Log gamma for spectacular dynamic range
the sensor to give your recordings amazing dynamic
range. In 4K and 2K modes, the camera will always
use Canon Log gamma. In MXF mode, you may
camera easily and quickly for shooting with Canon
Log gamma.
In 4K and 2K modes, the camera outputs image
data for recording with an external recorder. In 4K
mode, the camera outputs Canon RAW image data,
which is free of compression noise. In 2K mode, the
camera outputs up to an RGB 4:4:4 12-bit signal. In
MXF mode, the camera records HD audio and video
to CompactFlash (CF) cards. HD recordings are
saved as Material eXchange Format (MXF) files and
are compatible with major non-linear editing (NLE)
software. For example, you can use these MXF files
as proxy video for your NLE software. Furthermore,
even in 4K and 2K modes, the camera can record
MXF files on a CF card.
Operability and Adaptability
Freely customizable compact design
The modular components, including the supplied
handle unit and monitor unit will let you expand and
adapt the configuration to match your shooting
be rotated 270° for maximum convenience. The
10.1-cm (4-in.) LCD screen with 100% coverage
ensures that you can compose your shots with
ease.
Multitude of recording options
The camera offers you numerous options when it
comes to the video configuration of your recordings.
When recording in 4K or 2K mode, you can select
the recording mode (RAW, HRAW, RGB 4:4:4 12-
bit, RGB 4:4:4 10-bit or YCC 4:2:2 10-bit), system
frequency (59.94 Hz, 50.00 Hz, 24.00 Hz),
resolution (various settings from 1920x1080 to
4096x2160) and frame rate (various settings from
23.98P up to 59.94P). This allows you to select a
video configuration to suit your needs from a total of
44 different combinations. When recording in MXF
Pro-level connectivity
Other Features
In addition to the 3G-SDI terminals mentioned
previously, the HD/SD SDI terminal can output YCC
4:2:2 10-bit (8-bit effective) HD/SD video as well as
audio and time code signals. Genlock
camera to be part of any multi-camera shooting
setup.
Special recording modes
creative control over your recordings. You can create
a slow motion or fast motion effect in your
recordings, record a certain number of frames at a
set interval (ideal for nature shots and other subjects
with little movement) or record a certain number of
frames every time you press a button (ideal for stop
motion animation).
6
Customization
The camera features several customization options.
You can assign often-used functions to assignable
functions with the press of a single button. You can
also register frequently-used menu settings in an
control many aspects of the camera’s operation.
During MXF mode, with custom picture settings
to deliver the “look” you want by adjusting
parameters, such as gamma and sharpness. The
custom picture settings can be recorded onto an SD
card, which allows multiple C500 / C500 PL cameras
or C300 / C300 PL camcorders to use the same
settings, or embedded in the recording itself
Software for aiding the production workflow
The Cinema RAW Development software, which
can be downloaded from your local Canon Web site,
can develop the 4K RAW data recorded with an
external recorder and export it as a standard file type
such as DPX. This helps make a smooth transition to
the color grading process.
Audio
Sound is recorded as 2-channel linear PCM audio
(16-bit/48 kHz). You can use the MIC terminal for
microphones with a Ø 3.5 mm mini-stereo plug or the
two XLR audio input terminals (with phantom power
supply) when recording.
Video scopes
Check the brightness of the image using the
Remote operation via Wi-Fi
You can attach the optional WFT-E6 Wireless File
Transmitter to the camera and operate it remotely via
The Wi-Fi Remote application lets you monitor the
image through live view and remotely control the
focus, shutter speed, ISO speed/gain and other
settings.
Table of Contents
7
Checking the Available Recording Time for CF
Remote Operation Via the Wi-Fi Remote
Checking Clips Recorded with Canon Log Gamma
Video Configuration: Type of Recording,
Selecting the Video Configuration for 4K and 2K
Selecting the Video Configuration for MXF
Changing Main Camera Functions with the FUNC.
Connecting to a 4K- or 2K-Compatible External
8
Adding an $ Mark or % Mark to the Last Clip
Reference Video Signal Input (Genlock
Synchronization) 88
Embedding Custom Picture Settings in a
Recording 117
Connecting an External Microphone or External
Audio Input Source to the Camera 92
Selecting the Audio Input from the XLR
Terminals 93
Adjusting the Audio Level from the XLR
Terminals 94
Adjusting the Audio Level from the MIC
Terminal 95
Customizing Functions and Onscreen
Setting a User Memo Created with Canon XF
Utility 97
9
Installing and Uninstalling Cinema RAW
Development (Windows) 150
Installing and Uninstalling Cinema RAW
Development (Mac OS) 151
Installing and Uninstalling Canon XF Utility
(Windows) 153
Installing and Uninstalling Canon XF Utility
(Mac OS) 155
Deleting the User Memo and GPS
Information 136
Copying a Custom Picture File Embedded in a
Clip 136
Displaying a Frame Index Screen of a Single
Clip 138
Video Configuration and Video Output
Configuration for 4K and 2K Modes 141
Superimposing Onscreen Displays to Appear on
an External Monitor 149
10
Introduction
1
11
About this Manual
Thank you for purchasing the Canon EOS C500/C500 PL. Please read this manual carefully before you use the
camera and retain it for future reference. Should the camera fail to operate correctly, refer to Troubleshooting
Conventions Used in this Manual
•
•
IMPORTANT: Precautions related to the camera’s operation.
NOTES: Additional topics that complement the basic operating procedures.
• A: Reference page number.
• 2: Text that applies only to the model shown in the icon.
• The following terms are used in this manual.
“Screen” refers to the LCD screen and the viewfinder screen.
“CF card” refers to a CompactFlash (CF) card.
“SD card” refers to an SD or SDHC memory card.
“Recording media” refers to CF cards and SD cards.
• Photographs in the manual are simulated pictures en with a still camera. Some screenshots have been
altered to make them easier to read.
• Illustrations in the manual show the Canon EOS C500 camera with a Canon EF 50mm f/1.4 USM lens
attached.
About this Manual
The arrow is used to abbreviate menu
selections. For a detailed explanation on
how to use the menus, refer to Using the
of all available menu options and
settings, refer to the appendix Menu
Operating modes
indicates that a function is available in the
operating mode (the two icons left of the dividing bar)
and system priority (the three icons to the right of the
12
dividing bar) indicated and
indicates that the
function is not available. For a detailed explanation,
Setting the Time Code
While recording, the camera can generate a time code signal and embed it in your recordings. You can have the
camera output the time code signal from the 3G-SDI terminals, MON. terminals, HD/SD SDI terminal or TIME
CODE terminal (A 91). In addition, you can superimpose the time code on video output from the HDMI OUT
terminal or SYNC OUT terminal. While playing back video recorded on a CF card, you can output the time code
on the CF card from the HD/SD SDI terminal or TIME CODE terminal. Additionally, you can superimpose the time
code on the picture from the HDMI OUT terminal or SYNC OUT terminal. For recordings with a frame rate of
29.97P, 59.94i or 59.94P, you can also select between a drop frame and non-drop frame time code.
To synchronize the camera s time code to an external time code generator, refer to Synchronizing with an
External Device (A 88).
84
Operating modes:
Selecting the Running Mode
[¤ TC/UB Setup]
During MXF mode, you can select the running mode of the camera s time
code. During 4K and 2K modes, the running mode will be set to [Free
Run] during normal shooting and slow & fast recording mode; it will be set
[Time Code]
to [Rec Run] during interval recording and frame recording modes. Yo
can set the time codes initial value, however, by performing the procde
in the following section Setting the Time Code s Initial Value
[Mode]
[Preset]
1 Open the time code [Mode] submenu.
[¤ TC/UB Setup] > [Time Code] > [Mode
2 Select the desired option and then pess SET.
[¤ TC/UB Setup]
[Time Code]
[Run]
€ If you selected [Regen.], you do not ned to prform the rest of this
procedure. If you selected [Preset] and would like to set the time
codes initial value, see the following section Setting the Time Codes
Initial Value.
3 After you select [Preset], open the time code [Run] submenu.
[¤ TC/UB Setup] > [Time Code] > [Run]
[Free Run]
4 Select the desired option and then press SET.
Options
[Preset]: The time code starts from an initial value you can select in
advance. The default initial time code is 00:00:00.00. The time
code s running mode depends on the [Run] setting.
[Rec Run]: The time code runs only while recording so clips
recorded consecutively on the same CF card will have
continuous time codes.
[Free Run]:The time code starts running the moment you press
SET to select this option and keeps running regardless
of the camera s operation.
[Regen.]: The camera will read the selected CF card and the time code will
continue from the last recorded time code on the CF card. The
time code runs only while recording so clips recorded
consecutively on the same CF card will have continuous time
codes.
When a procedure requires selecting an option,
the available options are listed within or after the
procedure. Brackets [ ] are used to refer to menu
options as they are displayed on screen.
When a function requires the use of the menu,
the quick reference shows the submenus and,
when applicable, the default setting for the menu
item. The example illustration indicates that you
can find the function by selecting the [¤ TC/
UB Setup] menu and then the [Time Code]
menu item.
Supplied Accessories
Supplied Accessories
The following accessories are supplied with the camera.
13
Monitor Unit
Handle Unit
Body Cap1
Battery Charger CG-940
(incl. power cord)
BP-955 Battery Pack
(incl. terminal cover)
Eye Cup
Viewfinder Cap
CA-940 Compact Power Adapter
(incl. power cord)
DC-940 DC Cable
(incl. cable tie)
SS-1200 Shoulder Strap
Adapter Base for 0.64 cm (1/4 in.)
Tripods
WFT Attachment Bracket2
Tape Measure Hooks1 (x 2)
Canon XF Utilities Disc3
1
2
3
Comes pre-attached to the camera.
Used to secure the optional WFT-E6 Wireless File Transmitter, when it is attached to the camera.
The Canon XF Utilities Disc includes software for saving and managing MXF clips on a computer. For details on installing the
software, refer to Saving MXF Clips to a Computer (A 152). For more information on the functions, refer to the ‘Canon XF Utility
Instruction Manual’ (PDF file) after you install the software.
Names of Parts
3
2
16
24
20
21
25
26
19
22
23
23
2 EF Lens mount
3 PL Lens mount
Names of Parts
39
17
27
40
41
28
29
30
42
43
31
32
33
34
44
45
35
36
37
38
46
47 48 49
35
27 Viewfinder unit
43 CF card slot cover switches for CF card slots
45 SLOT SELECT (CF card slot selection) button
46 CF card release buttons for CF card slots A (top)
35 CF card slot covers for CF card slots A (top) and
B (bottom)
38 Battery compartment
47 BATT. OPEN (open battery compartment) switch
49 CF2 (CF card slot A) and CF3 (CF card slot B)
Names of Parts
18
51
52
53
54
53
50
50 Tape measure hooks
Use the hooks to accurately measure the distance
from the focal plane.
54 Accessory shoe with mounting hole for
0.64 cm (1/4 in.) screws
51
Focal plane marks
For attaching accessories such as the optional
V-10Li II Battery Video Light.
57
58
55
56
55 TB-1 Tripod Base for tripods with 0.95 cm (3/8 in.)
57 Attachment sockets for the optional TA-100 Tripod
4K Workflow Overview
4K Workflow Overview
The following illustrates the typical 4K workflow for this camera.
Operating modes:
23
Recording
Post-production
Full-quality
data
ᕡ
RAW data
ᕡ
ᕣ
ᕥ
3G-SDI
connection
Cinema
RAW
Development
External 4K
recorder
Color
grading
RAW recording
EDL
ᕤ
ᕢ
Proxy data
NLE
CF card
MXF data
Supplied
plugin
HD recording
ᕢ Insert a CF card into the camera to record an MXF clip simultaneously with the 4K RAW data
quality data.
• You can also generate proxy data with the software.
ᕤ Transfer the MXF file or proxy data generated by the software to your NLE system and edit offline
ᕥ Perform color grading based on the full-quality data and the edit decision list (EDL) created from
offline editing.
4K Workflow Overview
24
Preparations
2
25
Preparing the Power Supply
You can power the camera using a battery pack or directly using the compact power adapter. If you connect the
compact power adapter to the camera while a battery pack is attached, the camera will draw power from the
power outlet.
Charge battery packs before use. For approximate charging times and recording/playback times with a fully
Using a Battery Pack
You can power the camera using the supplied BP-955 or an optional BP-950G, BP-970G or BP-975 Battery
Pack*. The BP-955 and BP-975 are compatible with Intelligent System, meaning that you can check the
remaining battery time.
* The optional BP-970G / BP-975 Battery Pack was not originally designed for use with this camera. Because of its size, you will
Charging the Battery Pack
Charge battery packs using the supplied CG-940 Batterharger. Before
charging, remove the terminal cover of the battery p.
ቤ
1 Connect the power cord to the battery charger.
ቢ
2 Plug the power cord into a power outlet.
3 Attach the battery pack to the battery charger.
• Press lightly and slide the battery pack in the direction of the arrow until it clicks.
• The CHARGE indicator starts flashing and also indicates the battery pack’s
approximate charge. The indicator will stay on when charging has completed. CHARGE indicator
ባ
0-34%: Flashes once per second
35-69%: Flashes twice per second
70-99%: Flashes 3 times per second
4 When charging has completed, remove the battery pack from the battery charger.
5 Unplug the power cord from the power outlet and disconnect it from the battery charger.
IMPORTANT
• Do not connect to the battery charger any product that is not expressly recommended for use with this camera.
NOTES
• We recommend charging the battery pack in temperatures between 10 ºC and 30 ºC (50 ºF and 86 ºF).
Outside the temperature range of 0 ºC to 40 ºC (32 ºF to 104 ºF), charging will not start.
• If there is a malfunction with the battery charger or battery pack, the CHARGE indicator will go out and
charging will stop.
• Charged battery packs continue to discharge naturally. Therefore, charge them on the day of use, or the day
before, to ensure a full charge.
• We recommend that you prepare battery packs to last 2 to 3 times longer than you think you might need.
Preparing the Power Supply
Attaching the Battery Pack
1 Set the Q switch to OFF.
2 Slide the BATT. OPEN switch in the direction of the arrow and open
the battery compartment cover.
26
3 Insert the battery pack all the way into the compartment as shown
in the illustration and press it gently toward the left until it clicks.
4 Close the battery compartment cover.
Removing the Battery Pack
1 Set the Q switch to OFF.
2 Slide the BATT. OPEN switch in the direction of the arrow and open
the battery compartment cover.
3 Holding down the RELEASE latch, slide the battery pack ward the
right and then pull it out.
4 Close the battery compartment cover.
Checking the Remaining Battery Charge
When the camera is turned on, you can check the remaining battery
charge by looking at any recording/playback screen or the [Battery/Hour Meter] status screen (A 182). When
the camera is turned off, use one of the following methods to check the approximate remaining battery charge.
For batteries compatible with Intelligent System, press the CHECK
button. An indicator will light for approximately 3 seconds and show the
approximate remaining battery charge.
0-25%
CHECK button
26-50%
51-75%
76-100%
Battery charge indicator
Preparing the Power Supply
Press the BATT. INFO button to display the remaining battery level indicator
(displays for 5 seconds). Depending on the battery life, the battery information
may not be displayed.
27
NOTES
• The first time you use a battery pack, fully charge it and then use the
camera until the battery pack is completely exhausted. Doing so will ensure that the remaining recording time
will be displayed accurately.
• Repeatedly charging and discharging the battery pack will eventually shorten its battery life. You can check the
battery life on the [Battery/Hour Meter] status screen (A 182) or the battery information screen (press the
BATT. INFO button while the camera is turned off). Fully charging the battery pack and then discharging it will
give you a more accurate reading.
• USA and Canada only: The Lithium ion/polymer battery that powers the product is recyclable.
Please call 1-800-8-BATTERY for information on how to recycle this battery.
Using a Household Power Outlet
You can also power the camera directly from a power
outlet using the supplied CA-940 Compact Power
Adapter and DC-940 DC Cable.
1 Set the Q switch to OFF.
2 Connect the DC cable to the DC IN terminal on the
camera.
3 Connect the power cord to the compact power
adapter and plug it into a power outlet.
4 Connect the DC cable to the compact power adapter.
• You can use the supplied cable tie to secure the
cable and prevent the plug from being accidentally
disconnected.
DC IN
terminal
IMPORTANT
• Turn off the camera before connecting or disconnecting the compact power adapter.
NOTES
• When using the camera with a household power outlet, you can change the battery pack while the power is
on.
Preparing the Power Supply
Turning the Camera On and Off
The camera has two operating modes: CAMERA (
) mode for making recordings and MEDIA (
)
mode for playing back recordings. Select the operating mode using the Q switch.
28
To turn on the camera
Set the Q switch to CAMERA for
mode or MEDIA for
mode.
• If a message appears prompting you to open the MON./3G-SDI
terminal cover, open the cover to shoot in 4K or 2K mode.
CAMERA mode
MEDIA mode: Allows you to play
back recordings made on a CF card.
To turn off the camera
Set the Q switch to OFF.
Date, Time and Language Settings
Date, Time and Language Settings
Setting the Date and Time
You will need to set the date and time of the camera before you can start using it. When the camera’s clock is
not set, the [Date/Time] screen will appear automatically with the first field selected (month or day, depending on
the country/region of purchase).
29
Operating modes:
1 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to change the month/day then move (Ð) to the
next field.
• To move to the next field you can also press SET (press the joystick itself or press the SET button).
2 Change the rest of the fields in the same way.
3 Select (Ð) [Set] and then press SET to start the clck and close the screen.
NOTES
• You can change the date format and the clock format (12/24 hours) with the [w Other Functions] > [Set
Clock] > [Date Format] setting.
• You can also change the date and time later on (not during the initial setup) with the [w Other Functions] >
[Set Clock] > [Date/Time] setting.
• When the built-in rechargeable lithium battery is exhausted, the date and time setting may be lost. In such
Changing the Time Zone
[w Other Functions]
Change the time zone to match the time zone of your location. The default
setting is [UTC-05:00 New York] or [UTC+01:00 Central Europe],
depending on the country/region of purchase. The time zones are based
[Time Zone]
on Coordinated Universal Time (UTC).
[UTC-05:00 New York]
or
Operating modes:
[UTC+01:00 Central Europe]*
1 Press the MENU button.
* Depending on the country/region
of purchase.
2 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to select
[w Other Functions].
3 Select [Time Zone] in a similar fashion.
4 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to change the time zone.
5 Press SET to set the time zone and then press the MENU button to close the menu.
Date, Time and Language Settings
Displaying the Date and Time while Recording
[£ LCD/VF Setup]
[Custom Display 2]
[Date/Time]
You can display the date and time on the screen.
Operating modes:
30
1 Press the MENU button.
2 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to select
[£ LCD/VF Setup].
[Off]
3 Select [Custom Display 2] and then [Date/Time] in a similar fashion.
4 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to select the information to display.
• Select [Off] to record without displaying the date and time.
5 Press SET and then press the MENU button to close the menu.
• The selected date/time display will appear at the bottom of the screen.
Changing the Language
[w Other Functions]
The default language of the camera is English. You can change it to
German, Spanish, French, Italian, Polish, Russian, Simplified Chinese,
Korean or Japanese. Please note that some settings and screens will be
displayed in English, regardless of the language setting.
[Language !]
[English]
Operating modes:
1 Press the MENU button.
2 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to select [w Other Functions].
3 Select [Language !] in a similar fashion.
4 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to select a language.
5 Press SET to change the language and then press the MENU button to close the menu.
Using the Menus
Using the Menus
In
opens after pressing the MENU button. You can also register frequently used menu settings in a customized
submenu (My Menu) for easy access. In mode, press the MENU button to open the menu for general
mode, many of the camera’s functions can be adjusted from the menu for general settings, which
31
settings or SET to open the clip menu for clip operations. For details about the available menu options and
CANCEL
button
SET button
SELECT dial
MENU button
Joystick
CANCEL button
MENU button
Joystick
Push the joystick to move the
orange selection frame in the
menu. Then, press the joystick
itself or the SET button at the
center of the SELECT dial to select
the menu item indicated by the
orange selection frame.
MENU button
Press to open the menu and then press again to close the menu after
adjusting desired settings.
CANCEL utton
Pro return to the previous menu or to stop some operations that are
in pgress.
T button
Note that while only the joystick on the monitor unit is labeled as “SET”,
each joystick will function as the SET button when pressed down.
SELECT dial
Turn the dial to move the orange selection frame up or down in the menu.
Selecting an Option from the Menu
The following is a step-by-step explanation of how to select an option from the menu. In the procedures
throughout the rest of this manual, opening and closing the menu is assumed and not included in the procedure.
Operating modes:
1 Press the MENU button.
• The menu opens with the orange selection frame indicating the menu item that was selected the previous
time the menu was closed (unless the camera was turned off).
2 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to select the desired submenu.
3 Push the joystick right or press SET.
• The orange selection frame will appear on a menu item in the submenu.
• Press the CANCEL button, push the joystick left, or select [L] to return to the previous submenu.
4 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to select the desired menu item.
• If a submenu contains many menu items, a scroll bar will appear on the right side of the submenu indicating
that you must scroll up or down to see other menu items.
• A Ð mark next to a menu item indicates another submenu. Repeat steps 3 and 4.
Using the Menus
5 Push the joystick right or press SET.
• The orange selection frame will appear on a setting option.
• Press the CANCEL button to return to the previous submenu.
6 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to select the desired setting option and then
press SET.
32
• Depending on the menu item, additional selections may be necessary.
7 Press the MENU button to close the menu.
NOTES
• Unavailable items may appear grayed out.
• Pressing the MENU button at any time closes the menu.
Using the Customized Submenu (My Menu)
You can register up to 14 frequently used menu settings under the My Menu submenu for easy access.
Furthermore, if you set an assignable button to [My Menu] (A 111), you can press the button to access your
registered menu settings even faster and more easily.
Operating modes:
Adding Menu Settings
[¥ My Menu]
1 Open the My Menu [Register] screen.
[¥ My Menu] > [Edit] > [Register]
[Edit]
• The menu will change to blue to indicate you are selecting menu
settings to add to the My Menu submenu.
[Register]
2 Navigate the menus to find the menu setting you want to add and then
press SET.
3 Select [OK] and then press SET twice.
• The menu setting you registered will now appear under the My Menu submenu.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
Rearranging Menu Settings
[¥My Menu]
1 Open the My Menu [Move] screen.
[¥ My Menu] > [Edit] > [Move]
[Edit]
2 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to select the setting
you want to move and then press SET.
[Move]
• An orange ] icon will appear next to the setting you selected to
move.
3 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to move the setting to the desired position and then press
SET.
Using the Menus
Removing Menu Settings
[¥ My Menu]
1 Open the My Menu [Delete] screen.
[¥ My Menu] > [Edit] > [Delete]
[Edit]
33
2 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to select the setting
you want to remove and then press SET.
[Delete]
3 Select [OK] and then press SET twice.
Resetting the My Menu Submenu
[¥ My Menu]
[Edit]
1 Reset all the menu settings registered to the My Menu submenu.
[¥ My Menu] > [Edit] > [Reset All]
2 Select [OK] and then press SET twice.
[Reset All]
Preparing the Camera
Preparing the Camera
This section outlines the basic preparations for the camera such as attaching a lens and attaching the modular
units to the camera: monitor unit, handle unit, eye cup, etc. This section also covers how to adjust the viewfinder
and LCD screen. Your camera is nothing if not versatile and you can choose the configuration that best fits your
needs and shooting conditions.
34
Minimal configuration
Configuration with monitor
Configuration with monitor
and handle for easy carrying
NOTES
• When changing the camera’s configuration, be carefu
not to obstruct in any way the cooling fan’s air vents.
Exhaust vent
Intake vent
Intake vent
Preparing the Lens
As much as possible, attach and remove the lens quickly and in a clean environment free of dust. Refer also to
the instruction manual of the lens used.
IMPORTANT
• When attaching/removing a lens, avoid direct sunlight or strong light sources. Also, be careful not to drop the
camera or lens.
NOTES
• Be careful not to touch the lens mount or any components inside the lens mount area.
• Replace the body cap to the lens mount immediately after removing the lens from the camera.
• Keep the body cap clean and free from dust or dirt particles.
Preparing the Camera
Index mark
2 Attaching an EF Lens
1 Set the Q switch to OFF.
2 Turn the mount handle clockwise until it stops.
35
3 Remove the body cap from the camera and any dust caps from the
lens.
4 Align the lens and mount making sure that the index marks are
aligned.
• EF lenses: Align the red mark on the lens with the red EF Lens
mount index mark on the camera.
• EF-S lenses: Align the white mark on the lens with the white EF-S
Lens mount index mark on the camera.
5 After the lens is attached to the camera, without turning the lens,
turn the mount handle counter-clockwise until it is tightened firmly.
NOTES
• Turning on the image stabilization function of an EF lens may
reduce the effective usage time of the battery pack. When image
stabilization is not necessary, for example if the camera is fixed to a
tripod, it is recommended to turn it off.
• Depending on the lens used, you may experience one or more of the following limitations.
- The lens model name may be shortened when displayed n the screen.
- You may not be able to focus manually when the fomode switch is set to AF.
- You cannot use the focus preset (for super teleo lnses) or power zoom functions on lenses with those
functions.
2 Removing an EF Lens
1 Set the Q switch to OFF.
2 While holding the bottom of the lens, turn the mount handle
clockwise until it stops.
• Make sure not to drop the lens when removing it.
3 Replace the body cap to the camera and the dust cap to the lens.
Preparing the Camera
Changing a Lens While Maintaining the Time Code’s Progress
You can change the lens while the camera is turned on and the time
code is running.
36
Operating modes:
1 Press and hold the LENS EXCHANGE button for 1 second.
• The camera enters lens exchange mode and the tally lamp will
flash twice every 2 seconds. During this time, the time code will
continue running.
• While the camera is in lens exchange mode, only the Q
switch and LENS EXCHANGE button can be operated. Also, the LCD screen will turn off and output from
the video terminals will be put on hold.
2 Remove the lens attached to the camera and attach the new lens.
• Do not set the Q switch to OFF.
3 Press the LENS EXCHANGE button again.
• The camera exits lens exchange mode.
• Opening the CF card slot cover or removing the SD card will also exit lens exchange mode.
2 Peripheral Illumination Correction
Depending on the characteristics of the lens used, the image around the corners of the picture may seem darker
due to light fall-off or peripheral illumination drop. If the camera has correction data available for the EF lens used,
it can apply this correction data to compensate as neces.
Operating modes:
1 Attach the lens you want to use.
[~ Camera Setup]
2 Open the peripheral illumination correction screen.
[~ Camera Setup] > [Periph. Illum. Corr.]
• If correction data is available, the lens model name will appear on the
[Periph. Illum. Corr.]
screen.
[Off]
• If correction data is not available, [Periph. Illum. Corr.] will appear
grayed out. Visit your local Canon Web site and check if there is
correction data available for the lens you are using. If so, download the necessary update package and
upgrade the camera’s firmware following the instructions supplied therein.
3 Select [On] and then press SET.
• As long as [~ Camera Setup] > [Periph. Illum. Corr.] is set to [On], the camera will automatically apply the
appropriate correction data.
NOTES
• About lens correction data:
- The camera contains a register of correction data for compatible lenses that were available at the time the
camera went on sale. Correction data for future lenses will be made available as part of the regular updates
released for the camera’s firmware. For more details, visit your local Canon Web site.
- Depending on the recording conditions, noise may appear in the periphery of the image as a result of the
correction.
- The level of correction will be lower for lenses that cannot provide distance information.
- The level of correction will be lower the higher the ISO speed/gain setting used.
- No correction will be applied when correction data is not available for the lens attached.
- When using EF-S lenses, peripheral illumination fall-off may be more pronounced.
- When using non-Canon lenses, peripheral illumination will not be corrected.
Preparing the Camera
3 Attaching a PL Lens
1 Hold a bayonet ring handle and turn the bayonet ring counter-
clockwise to remove the body cap and remove any dust caps from
the lens.
37
2 Attach the lens to the camera aligning a groove on the lens with the
PL lens index pin on the mount.
3 Turn the bayonet ring clockwise to fix the lens in place.
PL lens index pin
3 Removing a PL Lens
1 Turn the bayonet ring handles counter-clockwise.
2 Remove the lens and replace the body cap to the camera and the
dust cap to the lens.
Attaching and Removing the Monitor Unit
You can attach the monitor unit to the accessory shn the camera or that on the handle unit. Further ahead
Attaching the Monitor Unit
1 Set the Q switch to OFF.
2 Insert the attachment base of the monitor unit to the camera’s or
the handle unit’s accessory shoe.
• Use the attachment base at the bottom of the monitor unit to
attach it directly to the camera. Use the attachment base at the
back of monitor unit to attach it to the accessory shoe on the
front of the handle unit.
3 Tighten the monitor unit’s lock screw.
4 Connect the monitor unit’s cables to the camera.
• Align the Î marks on the cables and terminals. Then, connect
cable number 1 (with the white line) to the camera’s EXT 1
terminal and cable number 2 to the EXT 2 terminal.
Removing the Monitor Unit
1 Set the Q switch to OFF.
2 Disconnect the monitor unit’s cables from the camera’s EXT 1 and EXT 2 terminals.
• Pull back the metallic tips of the cable to release the cable and then disconnect the cable.
3 Unscrew the lock screw and then gently slide out the monitor unit from the accessory shoe.
Preparing the Camera
Using the Viewfinder
Adjusting the Viewfinder’s Position
1 Gently pull out the viewfinder until it stops.
2 Adjust the viewfinder’s angle as necessary.
• The viewfinder unit can be adjusted up to 60º vertically.
38
Attaching and Detaching the Eye Cup
Attach the eye cup so that it covers the rubber portion of the
viewfinder unit.
• The dioptric adjustment dial can be operated even with the eye cup
attached.
• For left eye use, attach the eye cup so that the protruding portion
faces the opposite side.
Eye cup
Viewfinder
unit
Detach the eye cup as shown in the illustration.
Dioptric Adjustment
Dioptric
adjustment
dial
Turn on the camera and adjust the dioptric adjustment dial.
Preparing the Camera
Attaching the Viewfinder Cap
Pointing the viewfinder lens at the sun or other strong light sources
may cause damage to internal components. When you are not using
the viewfinder, make sure to attach the viewfinder cap to the
viewfinder. This will also protect the viewfinder from scratches and
dirt. Attach the viewfinder cap by inserting it into the rubber portion of
the viewfinder unit.
39
Using the LCD Panel
The whole monitor unit can be rotated 270º sideways allowing for
easy monitoring and operation from the side of the camera.
Additionally, the independently articulated LCD panel can be rotated
180º sideways and 270º up and down. In combination, you can
position the LCD panel at a comfortable angle whatever the shooting
style you need.
1 Rotate the monitor unit sideways to the desired angle.
2 Open the LCD panel and adjust the screen to the desired
position.
Adjusting the LCD Panel for Shoulder Mounted se
1 Open the LCD panel 90º until it is perpendicular to monitor unit.
2 Rotate the LCD panel 180º left.
3 Rotate the LCD panel 180º forward.
4 Press the MIRROR button until the image is displayed in the correct
orientation.
• Repeatedly pressing the MIRROR button will change the
displayed image in the following order: Image inverted
horizontally ´ Image inverted horizontally and vertically ´ Image
inverted vertically ´ Original image.
You can use the viewfinder and watch
the LCD screen at the same time
NOTES
• About the LCD and viewfinder screens: The screens are produced using extremely high-precision manufacturing
techniques, with more than 99.99% of the pixels operating to specification. Less than 0.01% of the pixels may
occasionally misfire or appear as black, red, blue or green dots. This has no effect on the recorded image and
does not constitute a malfunction.
• When you use a commercially available lens adapter and the image on the screen is inverted, you can use the
[w Other Functions] > [Custom Function] > [Scan Reverse Rec] setting to return the image to the correct
orientation. You can record this corrected image or have the camera output it from the 3G-SDI terminal, MON.
terminal, HD/SD SD terminalI or HDMI OUT terminal.
• If you are not interested in using the viewfinder while the monitor unit is attached, you can set [£ LCD/VF
Setup] > [LCD/VF Simul.] to [Off] to conserve the camera’s power. Even when [LCD/VF Simul.] is set to [Off],
closing the LCD panel will automatically activate the viewfinder.
• While recording with the LCD panel rotated in a different direction or angle (for example, facing toward the
subject), you can press the MIRROR button repeatedly to invert the image on the screen horizontally, vertically
or both ways.
Preparing the Camera
Adjusting the Viewfinder/LCD Screen
[£ LCD/VF Setup]
You can adjust the brightness, contrast, color, sharpness, and backlight
of the viewfinder and LCD screen independently of each other. These
adjustments will not affect your recordings.
[LCD Setup]
[VF Setup]
40
Operating modes:
[Brightness: 0]
[Contrast: 0]
[Color: 0]
[Sharpness: 2]
[Backlight: Normal]
1 Open the setup menu for the viewfinder or LCD screen.
[£ LCD/VF Setup] > [LCD Setup] or [VF Setup]
2 Select [Brightness], [Contrast], [Color], [Sharpness] or [Backlight] and
then press SET.
3 Adjust the setting and then press SET.
• Repeat steps 2 and 3 to adjust other settings as necessary.
NOTES
• If you set an assignable button to [LCD Setup] or [VF Setup] (A 111), you can press the button to open the
respective submenu.
Setting the Screen to Black & White
[£ LCD/VF Setup]
The viewfinder and LCD screen display in color by default but you can set
them to black & white. Even when the screen is black & white, onscreen
text and icons will still be displayed in color.
[LCD/VF B&W]
[Off]
Operating modes:
1 Open the [LCD/VF B&W] submenu.
[£ LCD/VF Setup] > [LCD/VF B&W]
2 Select [On] and then press SET.
NOTES
• If you set an assignable button to [LCD/VF B&W] (A 111), you can press the button to turn the black & white
display on and off.
5.5 mm
Using a Tripod
The camera is shipped with the TB-1 Tripod Base for tripods with 0.95 cm (3/8 in.)
screws. You can mount the camera on a tripod but do not use tripods with mounting
screws longer than 5.5 mm (0.2 in.) as this may cause damage to the camera.
Preparing the Camera
Using a Tripod with 0.64 cm (1/4 in.) Mounting Screws
To use a tripod with 0.64 cm (1/4 in.) mounting screws, first attach
the supplied tripod adapter base to the camera and then attach
the tripod to the adapter base.
41
1 Remove the original TB-1 tripod base from the camera.
• Remove the 4 screws and then remove the base.
2 Attach the supplied tripod adapter base for 0.64 cm (1/4 in.)
tripods.
• Firmly screw in the 4 screws.
3 Attach the tripod.
• Firmly screw in the tripod screw.
Attaching the Handle Unit
1 Insert the attachment base at the bottom of the handle unit to the
camera’s accessory shoe.
2 Tighten the handle unit’s lock screw while gently pressing it down.
NOTES
• You can use the accessory shoe or the socket for 0.64 cm (/4 in.)
screws on the handle unit to attach a variety of commeally
available accessories.
Attaching a Shoulder Strap
Pass the ends through the strap mount and adjust the length of
the strap.
IMPORTANT
• Be careful not to drop the camera when attaching or adjusting the
shoulder strap.
Preparing the Camera
Removing and Attaching the Terminal Covers
You can remove the plastic covers of the following terminals and SD card slot to access them more readily. For
information on removing the MON./3G-SDI terminal cover, refer to Connecting to a 4K- or 2K-Compatible
42
• EXT 1 and EXT 2
• SYNC OUT
• DC IN
• SD card slot
• REMOTE and HDMI OUT
• MIC
• GENLOCK and TIME CODE
• HD/SD SDI
• CH1 and CH2
(XLR terminals on the monitor unit)
• × (headphones)
• WFT terminal
• GRIP terminal
Removing the Terminal Covers
Open the terminal cover and gently pull it straight out.
Attaching the Terminal Covers
Insert the connecting strip into the opening to attach the terminal cover.
NOTES
• If the connecting strip is difficult to grasp, use a pair of teezers or similar
tool.
Connecting to a 4K- or 2K-Compatible External Recorder
Connecting to a 4K- or 2K-Compatible External Recorder
When you use this camera to make 4K or 2K recordings, you must connect the camera to an external recorder*
using the 3G-SDI terminals. In addition to a video signal, the 3G-SDI terminals output an audio signal, time code
signal, metadata and clip name information. Output from the 3G-SDI terminal is enabled by default but if it has
been disabled, you must enable it after you connect the camera to the external recorder.
43
Refer also to the external recorder’s instruction manual for details on how to record.
* To make 4K recordings, the external recorder must be compatible with Canon RAW files. Refer to Canon’s Web site for the latest
information on compatible recorders.
Operating modes:
1 Unscrew the screw on the MON./3G-SDI terminal cover and pull
the cover out.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[3G-SDI Output]
[On]
2 Connect two commercially available BNC cables to the camera’s
3G-SDI terminals and the external recorder.
• Refer to the external recorder’s instruction manual for details.
3 Open the [3G-SDI Output] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [3G-SDI Output]
4 Select [On] and then press SET.
IMPORTANT
• After you connect the camera to the external recorder, make a test recording first to check if they are operating
correctly.
NOTES
• You can also remove the MON./3G-SDI terminal cover by sliding the screw toward the back of the camera and
then pulling it outward along with the cover.
• If you do not intend to use the 3G-SDI terminals in other situations, set the camera to MXF mode (A 65 ) and
then close the MON./3G-SDI terminal cover in order to conserve the camera’s power. When you do so, the
camera can record only in MXF mode.
Connecting to a 4K- or 2K-Compatible External Recorder
Video signal output from the 3G-SDI terminals
The following summarizes the video signal output from the 3G-SDI terminals for general shooting situations. The
figures in parentheses apply to 2K mode.
Output signal
44
System priority /
3G-SDI 1
terminal
3G-SDI 2
terminal
Frame rate
Recording mode
1
1
59.94P
29.97P
23.98P
50.00P
25.00P
24.00P
59.94P
50.00P
29.97P
29.97P
2
2
29.97P
29.97P
4K / RAW
2
2
23.98P
23.98P
2K /
2K /
12-bit
10-bit
1
1
25.00P
25.00P
2
2
25.00P
25.00P
2
2
24.00P
2
24.00P
2
2
2
29.97PsF (59.94P )
29.97PsF (59.94P )
4K / HRAW
10-bit
2
2
2
2
2K /
25.00PsF (50.00P )
25.00PsF (50.00P )
1
2
Both 3G-SDI 1 terminal and 3G-SDI 2 terminal are required. The output from each terminal differs by one frame.
The signals output from 3G-SDI 1 terminal and 3G-SDI 2 terminal are the same.
The following summarizes the video signal output from the 3G-SDI terminals for slow & fast motion mode.
Video configuration
Output signal
System priority /
Recording mode
System
frequency
Frame rate
(slow & fast motion)
3G-SDI 1
terminal
3G-SDI 2
terminal
2
2
1 30
1 to 30P
1 to 30P
59.94 Hz
24.00 Hz
4K / RAW
1
3
32 60
32 to 60P
2K /
2K /
12-bit
10-bit
2
2
to 25
1 to 25P
1 to 25P
50.00 Hz
1
3
26 to 50
26 to 50P
2
2
1 to 60
1 to 60P
1 to 60P
59.94 Hz
24.00 Hz
1
3
62 to 120
62 to 120P
4K / HRAW
10-bit
2
2
2K /
1 to 50
1 to 50P
1 to 50P
50.00 Hz
1
3
52 to 100
52 to 100P
1
When the shooting frame rate is enclosed by brackets on the screen, this indicates that both 3G-SDI terminals are necessary to
record the 3G-SDI output signal using an external recorder.
The signals output from 3G-SDI 1 terminal and 3G-SDI 2 terminal are the same.
Both 3G-SDI terminals combine to output this signal.
2
3
NOTES
• Depending on the external recorder, you may not be able to record at the desired video configuration.
Preparing Recording Media
Preparing Recording Media
The camera records MXF clips to 1 CompactFlash (CF) cards and photos* to . SD and / SDHC memory
cards. The camera is equipped with two CF card slots. Initialize recording media (A 47) when you use them
with this camera for the first time.
45
* The camera can record custom picture files and a camera settings file onto the SD card as well. The SD card serves also to store
user memo files created with the supplied software Canon XF Utility that you can then read and embed in the clips’ metadata.
Compatible CF cards
You can use UDMA-compatible* Type I CF cards with a capacity of at least 512 MB with the camera. For more
details on cards that can be used, visit your local Canon Web site.
* The Ultra Direct Memory Access (UDMA) specification allows data to be transferred between the CF card and device at high
transfer speeds (measured in MB/s). Depending on the CF card, you may not be able to record even when using a UDMA-
comptaible CF card.
NOTES
• Proper operation cannot be guaranteed for all CF cards.
Inserting a CF Card
You can insert a CF card into CF card slot A or slot B. If you have two
CF cards, you can use both slots.
1 Slide the CF card slot cover switch in the directiof the
arrow.
• The CF card slot cover will open upward (sot A) ownward
(slot B).
2 Insert the CF card straight, with the label facing up, all the
way into the slot.
3 Close the CF card slot cover.
• Do not force the cover closed if the CF card is not correctly
inserted.
Checking the Status of the CF Card Slots
You can check the status of the CF card slots immediately by looking
at the CF2/CF3 access indicator. Refer to the following table.
Access indicator color
Red
CF card slot status
Accessing CF card.
Recording/playback is possible and the CF card slot is
selected for recording/playback.
Green
A CF card is not inserted, the CF card slot is not currently
selected, or the CF card is not being accessed.
Indicator off
Preparing Recording Media
Removing a CF card
,
1 Wait until the access indicator for the card slot with the CF
card to be removed is off.
46
2 Slide the CF card slot cover switch in the direction of the arrow.
• The CF card slot cover will open upward (slot A) or downward
(slot B).
3 Push the CF card release button.
• The release button partially pops out.
,
4 Push in the CF card release button to release the CF card.
5 Pull the CF card all the way out and close the CF card slot
cover.
IMPORTANT
• Observe the following precautions while the CF2 or CF3 access
indicator is illuminated in red. Failure to do so may result in
permanent data loss.
- Do not disconnect the power source or turn off the camera.
- Do not open the cover of the CF card slot being accessed.
NOTES
• If you set the [w Other Functions] > [Media Access LE] function to [Off], the access indicators will not
illuminate.
Inserting and Removing an SD Card
1 Turn off the camera.
2 Open the SD card slot cover.
3 Insert the SD card all the way into the SD card slot until it
clicks.
SD card access
indicator
• The SD card slot is positioned at an angle. Align the SD card
straight in relation to the SD card slot, with the label facing the lens.
4 Close the SD card slot cover.
• Do not force the cover closed if the SD card is not correctly inserted.
IMPORTANT
• Observe the following precautions while the SD card access
indicator is flashing. Failure to do so may result in permanent data loss.
- Do not disconnect the power source or turn off the camera.
- Do not remove the SD card.
• Turn off the camera before inserting or removing an SD card. Inserting or removing the SD card with the
camera on may result in permanent data loss.
• SD cards have front and back sides that are not interchangeable. Inserting an SD card facing the wrong
direction can cause a malfunction of the camera. Be sure to insert the SD card as described in step 3.
NOTES
• To remove the SD card: Push the SD card once to release it. When the SD card springs out, pull it all the way
out.
Preparing Recording Media
• If you set the [w Other Functions] > [Media Access LED] function to [Off], the access indicators will not
illuminate.
Initializing the Recording Media
47
The first time you use any recording media with this camera, initialize it first. You can also initialize a recording
media to permanently delete all the data it contains.
When initializing an SD card, you can select quick initialization, which clears the file allocation table but does not
physically erase the stored data, or complete initialization, which deletes all data completely.
Operating modes:
1 Open the [Initialize Media] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Initialize Media]
[w Other Functions]
2 Select [CF A], [CF B] or [SD Card] and then press SET.
[Initialize Media]
To initialize a CF card
3 Select [OK] and then press SET.
4 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
• The CF card is initialized and all the data it contains is erased.
To initialize an SD card
3 Select [Complete] (complete initialization) or [Quick] (quick initialization) and then press SET.
4 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• If you are using the [Complete] initialization optipress SET twice to cancel the operation while it is in
progress. You can use the SD card but all data wbe erased.
5 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
• The SD card is initialized and all the data it contains is erased.
IMPORTANT
• Initializing a recording media will permanently erase all data, including clips with an $ mark, protected photos,
and custom picture files. Lost data cannot be recovered. Make sure you save important recordings in
advance.
• Depending on the SD card, the complete initialization may take up to a few minutes.
NOTES
• While recording on a CF card, you can initialize another CF card in the other CF card slot.
• If you set an assignable button to [Initialize Media] (A 111), you can press the button to open the initialization
submenu.
Preparing Recording Media
Switching Between the CF Card Slots
The camera features two CF card slots, CF2 (CF card slot A) and
CF3 (CF card slot B). If both slots contain a CF card, you can switch
between them as necessary.
48
Operating modes:
Press the SLOT SELECT button.
• The access indicator of the selected CF card slot will illuminate in
green. On the screen, the CF card selected is indicated with a Ð
mark next to the CF card icon and in the rear panel, with a Î mark
on top of the CF card icon.
NOTES
• If both CF card slots contain a CF card and you open the cover of the selected
slot, the camera will automatically switch to the other slot.
• You cannot use the SLOT SELECT button to switch between CF card slots
while recording.
• When using an optional WFT-E6 Wireless File Transmitter, you can also switch
between CF card slots remotely by pressing [SLOT SELECT] on the Wi-Fi
Remote screen.
Selecting the CF Card Recording Metho
The camera features two useful CF card recording methods, relay recording and double slot recording.
Relay recording: This allows you to continue recording on another CF card without interruption if the CF card you
are using becomes full. Relay recording is available from CF card slot A to CF card slot B, and vice versa.
Double slot recording: This records the same clip simultaneously to both CF cards, which is a convenient way to
make a backup copy of your recording while you record.
Operating modes:
To use relay recording
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[Set CF Card Slot]
[Relay Rec]
By default, this function is activated. If it has been deactivated, follow the
procedure below to activate it.
1 Open the [Relay Rec] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Set CF Card Slot] > [Relay Rec]
2 Select [On] and then press SET.
[On]
To use double slot recording
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[Set CF Card Slot]
[Double Slot Rec]
[Off]
1 Open the [Double Slot Rec] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Set CF Card Slot] > [Double Slot Rec]
2 Select [On] and then press SET.
NOTES
available during slow motion recording.
Preparing Recording Media
• If a CF card becomes full during double slot recording, recording on both cards will stop. On the other hand, if
an error occurs with one of the cards, recording will continue on the other card.
• Double slot recording cannot be used with relay recording or slow & fast motion recording.
49
Checking the Available Recording Time for CF Cards
When the camera is in
mode, the display on the upper left of the screen indicates which CF card slot is in
use and the available recording time (in minutes*) that remains on each CF card. The same information is
displayed in the rear panel. When the camera is in
the rear panel.
mode, the available recording time is displayed only in
On the [Media] status screen (A 180), you can check the available recording time, total space and used space
of each recording media, and the available number of photos.
Recovering Data on the CF Card
Some actions, such as suddenly turning off the camera or removing the CF card while data is being recorded,
can cause data errors on the CF card. In such case, you may be able to recover the data on the CF card.
Operating modes:
1 Insert the CF card with the data to be recovered ithe camera.
2 When the screen prompts you to recover the , select [Yes] and then press SET.
3 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
NOTES
• This procedure will delete clips shorter than 10 seconds in length. Additionally, up to 10 seconds will be
deleted from the end of clips on the CF card.
• In some cases, data may not be recovered, such as when the FAT32 file system is corrupted or the CF card is
physically damaged.
• While recording on a CF card, you can recover data from another CF card by inserting it into the other CF card
slot.
Adjusting the Black Balance
Adjusting the Black Balance
You can have the camera adjust the black balance automatically when ambient temperature changes
considerably or if there is a noticeable change in a true black video signal.
50
Operating modes:
1 Open the [ABB] screen.
[~ Camera Setup]
[~ Camera Setup] > [ABB]
[ABB]
2 Attach the body cap to the lens mount.
• If a lens was attached, remove the lens and replace the body cap.
3 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The automatic black balance procedure will start.
4 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
• If the body cap is not correctly attached, [Error] will appear on the screen. Press SET and repeat the
procedure from the beginning.
NOTES
• Adjusting the black balance may be necessary in the following cases:
- When using the camera for the very first time or after a long period of not using it.
- After sudden or extreme changes in ambient temperature.
- After changing the ISO speed/gain settings.
• The automatic black balance procedure will take approxately 40 seconds when the frame rate is set to
23.98P or 24.00P.
• During the adjustment of the black balance, you may notice some irregular displays appear on the screen. This
is not a malfunction.
• Resetting the camera’s settings using the [w Other Functions] > [Reset] > [All Settings] or [Camera
Settings] menu option will reset also the black balance adjustment. In such case, perform the procedure again.
Remote Operation Via the Wi-Fi Remote Application
Remote Operation Via the Wi-Fi Remote Application
You can attach an optional WFT-E6 Wireless File Transmitter to the camera and operate the
camera remotely via Wi-Fi Remote, a Web browser application that can be accessed using
the Web browser on any device compatible with Wi-Fi networks*. The Wi-Fi Remote
application lets you monitor the image through live view, start and stop recording and
remotely control the shutter speed, ISO speed/gain and other settings. You can also create,
edit and transfer a metadata profile, set various shot marks and check the recording media,
remaining recording time, time code, etc.
51
* For details about compatible devices, operating systems, Web browsers, etc. please visit your local Canon
Web site.
Operating modes:
Preparing the System for Wi-Fi Remote
To be able to operate the camera remotely via the Wi-Fi Remote application you will need to attach an optional
WFT-E6 Wireless File Transmitter to the camera’s WFT terminal and complete the wireless network setup.
Download ‘WFT-E6 Wireless File Transmitter - Guide for Canon Camcorders’ (PDF file) from your local Canon
Web site and follow the instructions to complete the necessary setup.
Remote Operation Via the Wi-Fi Remote Application
52
Recording
3
53
Recording Video
This section explains the recording basics. Before you use an external recorder, make sure it is operating
correctly. Before you begin recording on a CF card, make a test recording first to check if the camera is operating
correctly. Record for approximately 6 minutes at 50 Mbps (A 62). Should the camera fail to operate correctly,
Operating modes:
Preparing to Record
1 Attach the monitor unit, handle unit, etc. as necessary to build the
• Insert another CF card into the other CF card slot to e relay recording
5 To make 4K and 2K recordings, connect the camera to an external
6 Adjust the viewfinder.
NOTES
• The camera can add a user memo (A 97) to an MXF clip as you record. It can be used to store information
such as the clip name, camera operator and filming location. However, you must set the user memo before
recording.
Recording
• The camera turns on in
record pause mode.
mode and enters
• When a CF card is in the camera, the access
indicator for the CF card slot selected for recording
illuminates in red and then changes to green.
Tally lamp
2 Open the [System Priority] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [System Priority]
Access indicators
Recording Video
3 Select [4K], [2K] or [MXF] and then press SET.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[System Priority]
[4K]
• The system priority changes to the selected menu item. Hereafter,
each mode will be referred to in this manual as “4K mode”, “2K
mode” and “MXF mode”, respectively.
54
• Select [4K] or [2K] to record a 4K or 2K clip* on an external recorder.
Select [MXF] to record only an MXF clip (HD video) on a CF card.
• During 4K mode, [RAW] appears on the upper right of the screen and
the
icon appears on the rear panel.
* “Clip” refers to one movie unit from the point you press the START/STOP button to
start recording until you press again to pause the recording. You can also include custom picture settings (A 114) and metadata
4 Press the START/STOP button to begin recording.
• During 4K and 2K modes:
- Recording starts and a signal is sent to an external recorder
connected to the HD/SD SDI or 3G-SDI terminals instructing it
to start recording. [ÜREC `] appears at the upper center of
the screen and the tally lamp illuminates.
- If there is a CF card in a CF card slot, the camera
simultaneously records an MXF clip on the card. In such case,
[ÜREC] appears on the upper left of the screen.
- Depending on the aspect ratio of the 4K or 2K video, you can
select the resizing method when recordings on the CF card are
• During MXF mode:
- Recording starts. The tally lamp illuminates anREC]
appears on the upper center of the scree.
- If an external recorder is connected to the HD/SD SDI terminal, a signal is sent instructing it to start
recording. [ÜREC`] appears on the center right of the screen.
• You can use the START/STOP button on the back of the camera, the front of the camera (next to the lens
mount), or the monitor unit.
5 Press the START/STOP button to pause the recording.
• Recording stops and a signal is sent to the external recorder to pause the recording. When recording on a
CF card, a clip is recorded and the camera enters record pause mode. [STBY`] or [STBY] appears at the
top of the screen. The tally lamp will also go out.
Remote Operation Using Wi-Fi Remote
After completing the necessary preparations (A 51) you can start and stop recording from a Wi-Fi-enabled
device using the Wi-Fi Remote application.
1 Press [LIVE VIEW ON/OFF] to show the camera’s live view image on the Wi-Fi Remote screen.
2 Press [START/STOP] to begin recording.
• The recording operation indicator changes from [STBY] to [ÜREC], the center of the START/STOP button
lights up in red and the time code display starts running on the Wi-Fi Remote screen.
• Press [START/STOP] again to pause the recording.
Recording Video
Recording operation
Time code
55
Locking the Controls in Recording Mode
Once in
mode, you can set the Q switch to C (key lock)
to lock all the physical controls (buttons and switches) on the camera*,
save for the START/STOP button. In such case, you can use Wi-Fi
Remote to operate the camera. This is useful in preventing settings from
being changed due to inadvertently pressing one of the buttons. Return
the Q switch to the CAMERA position to reactivate the controls.
* The Wi-Fi Remote application also has a key lock function that is limited ony to the
controls on the application’s screens (you will still be able to use the controon the
camera). Press [D] to lock the application’s controls; press [C] to rvate hem.
About Clips
When the camera records an MXF clip, it also assgns a 6-character
clip name consisting of a 2-character prefix (letters or numerals) and 4 numerals (for example, “AA0001”). The
last 4 numbers serve as a running counter that increases every time a clip is recorded. You can set the initial
clip name in advance using the [ 4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Clip Name] > [Title Prefix] and [Number Setting]
settings. You cannot change the clip name after the clip is recorded.
In 4K and 2K modes, the clip name is included with the video signal that is output from the 3G-SDI terminals.
If you use the software Cinema RAW Development to develop RAW clips recorded with an external recorder
and export them, MXF clips recorded on a CF card and the exported files can be given similar names to make
post-production more efficient. In the following cases, the clip name is not sent to the external recorder.
• During MXF mode.
• When the CF card in the camera cannot be recorded on, does not have enough available space or has an access
error.
• During 4K and 2K modes, when using the interval recording, frame recording or slow & fast motion
recording modes.
• When [ 4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Rec Command] is set to [Off].
NOTES
• When recording MXF clips, the following apply.
- If you are recording with two CF cards and the CF card you are using becomes full while recording, the
clip will continue uninterrupted on the other CF card when relay recording (A 48) is activated. In such
case, the recording will be recorded as separate clips.
- If you record using the custom picture and metadata settings, those settings will be recorded with the
- The video (stream) file in a clip will be split approximately every 2 GB for clips with a long recording time
(approximately every 1 GB during slow motion recording). Even in such case, playback will be continuous.
Recording Video
IMPORTANT
• Observe the following precautions while the CF2 or CF3 access indicator is illuminated in red. Failure to do
so may result in permanent data loss.
- Do not open the CF card slot cover of the CF card slot being accessed and remove the CF card.
- Do not disconnect the power source or turn off the camera.
56
• Be sure to save your recordings regularly (A 152), especially after making important recordings. Canon shall
not be liable for any loss or corruption of data.
NOTES
• By default, [ 4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Rec Command] is set to [On]. With this function, when you connect the
camera to another device using the 3G-SDI terminals (in 4K and 2K modes) or HD/SD SDI terminal (in MXF
mode), if you start or stop recording with the camera, the other device will also start or stop recording.
• By default, [w Other Functions] > [Fan] is set to [On] and the internal cooling fan will be activated at all times.
You can also set the fan to activate when the camera’s internal temperature has risen to a predetermined level.
• When recording MXF clips, the following apply.
- You can use [w Other Functions] > [Rec Review] (A 104) to review part or all of the last clip recorded.
- If you set an assignable button to [Add $ Mark] or [Add % Mark] (A 111), you can press the button to
add an $ mark or % mark to the last clip recorded.
- You can use [w Other Functions] > [Delete Last Clip] (A 175) to delete the last clip recorded. However,
you cannot delete the last clip if double slot recording is on.
Recording Video
Onscreen Displays
Refer to this section for an explanation of the various screen displays that appear in
mode. You can use
the custom display function (A 123) to turn off individual onscreen displays if they are not required.
57
10
11
12
13 14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
24
25
26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33
34
1
2
During 4K and 2K modes: CF card recording
During MXF mode: Remaining recording time for
2 Current focal length of an attached EF lens
Temperature warning / Fan
17 Available number of photos
1
3
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
20 Frame rate (shooting frame rate during slow &
21 During MXF mode: Recording command status
2
network; yellow - connecting to or disconnecting
from a Wi-Fi network.
12 During 4K and 2K modes: Recording command
status
1
2
3
The displayed value is an estimate.
Only when an optional WFT-E6 Wireless File Transmitter is connected to the camera.
During 4K and 2K modes, when the shooting frame rate is enclosed by brackets, this indicates that both 3G-SDI terminals are
necessary to record the 3G-SDI output signal on an external recorder.
NOTES
• You can press the DISP. button to switch the onscreen displays in the following sequence.
Show all onscreen displays ꢀ show only onscreen markers* ꢀ hide all onscreen displays.
* Only when the [£ LCD/VF Setup] > [Markers] setting is enabled.
Recording Video
1
2
CF card status/available recording time
• The following indicates the CF card status.
2/3 Can record on CF card
58
4/5 No CF card or cannot record on CF card
The CF card selected for recording is indicated with a Ð mark.
CF card recording operation (4K and 2K modes)
• When double slot recording (A 48) is activated, the 4 icon will appear to the left of the operation
indicator.
10 Remaining battery time
• The icon shows a rough estimate of the remaining charge as a percentage of the full charge of the
battery pack. The remaining recording/playback time of the battery pack is displayed, in minutes, next to
the icon.
• è ꢀ é ꢀ ê ꢀ ë ꢀ ì (in red).
When ì is displayed, replace the battery pack with a fully charged one.
• Depending on the conditions under which the camera and the battery pack are used, the actual battery
charge may not be indicated accurately.
12 Recording command status (4K and 2K modes) / Recording operation (MXF mode)
ÜREC`
Recording
STBY`
Record pause
ÜINT REC`
INT STBY (INT flashes)`
ÜFRM REC`
ÜFRM STBY`
Interval recording
Interval record pause
Frame recording
Frame record pauster starting recording)
FRM STBY (FRM flashes)` Frame record pause (before starting recording)
ÜS&F REC`
S&F STBY`
ÜPRE REC
Slow & fast motion recording
Slow & fast motion record pause
Pre-recording (after pressing the START/STOP button)
Pre-recording (before pressing the START/STOP button)
PRE REC STBY
• In MXF mode, when double slot recording (A 48) is activated, the 4 icon will appear to the left of the
operation indicator. Also, ` does not appear in the indicator.
• Pre-recording is available only during MXF mode.
Recording Video
Rear Panel Displays
You can check the following information on the rear panel. This allows you to easily adjust main camera functions
like the shutter speed, white balance and ISO speed/gain even when the monitor unit is not attached to the
camera without having to use the viewfinder.
59
5 6
7
8 9
10
11
12
1
2
3
13
4
1
2
8
9
EXT-LOCK External time code signal locked
11 Approximate remaining battery time
13 F card status and available recording time
1
4
3
4
5
6
7
1
1
ISO speed/
2
Shutter speed (mode set to [Speed], [Slow]
or [Off])
Shutter speed (mode set to [Angle])
Shutter speed (mode set to [Clear Scan])
3
3
1
Displayed also in
In these shutter speed modes, only the denominator is displayed -
Only displayed while adjusting the setting.
mode.
2
3
4
indicates a shutter speed of 1/100, etc.
Only when an optional WFT-E6 Wireless File Transmitter is connected to the camera.
Adjusting the Brightness of the Rear Panel
Repeatedly pressing the
(backlight) button will change the brightness of
the rear panel in the following order: Backlight on (bright) ꢀ Backlight on
(dim) ꢀ Backlight off.
Recording Video
Canon Log Gamma and CINEMA Preset
The Canon Log gamma setting makes full use of the newly developed image sensor to offer spectacular
dynamic range.
60
When you record clips on an external recorder in 4K and 2K modes, the
camera applies Canon Log gamma to video output from the 3G-SDI
terminals and MON. terminals*. When you record MXF clips on a CF card,
and other settings. Alternatively, you can record MXF clips using CINEMA
preset, which is comprised of a number of picture-related settings especially
designed with motion picture production in mind. Refer to the following table
for a summary.
[~ Camera Setup]
[/ CINEMA Locked]
[On]
System
priority
Output terminal/
Recording destination
[/ CINEMA Locked]
Picture setting
setting
3G-SDI terminals
MON. terminals
–
Canon Log gamma
–
Canon Log gamma with or without a LUT applied
CINEMA preset settings with Canon Log gamma
Based on custom picture settings
4K
2K
[On]
[Off]
[On]
[Off]
CF card
CF card
CINEMA preset settings with Canon Log gamma
Based on custom picture settings
MXF
Clips recorded using Canon Log gamma need to be processed n post-production by applying a LUT (look-up
table). By fine-tuning the LUT you use in post-production you can perfectly realize the artistic vision you desire. For
more details about available LUTs, visit your local Canon Wsite.
* You can also apply a LUT to the MON. terminal output.
Setting CINEMA Preset
1 Open the [/ CINEMA Locked] submenu.
[~ Camera Setup] > [/ CINEMA Locked]
2 Select [On] and then press SET.
• All picture-related settings will be set according to the CINEMA preset values. As such, you will not be able
to adjust custom picture settings.
• [/ LOCKED] appears on the left of the screen.
Checking Clips Recorded with Canon Log Gamma (View Assistance)
When Canon Log gamma is used, the image displayed on the screen will appear darker than usual. When you are
shooting with Canon Log gamma and are checking the picture on an external monitor connected to a MON. terminal,
you can apply a LUT to the output (A 146). In addition, you can use the view assistance function to display an image
that approximates the one that would be obtained using normal gamma settings. View assistance is only applied on
the camera screen; it will not affect your recordings or the video signal output from the various terminals.
1 Open the [View Assist.] submenu.
[£ LCD/VF Setup]
[£ LCD/VF Setup] > [View Assist.]
2 Select [On] and then press SET.
[View Assist.]
• O will appear on the lower left of the screen.
[Off]
NOTES
the button to enable the view assistance function.
Recording Video
Using the Internal Cooling Fan
During
mode, the camera uses an internal cooling fan that is always on by default to reduce the camera’s
internal heat. Alternatively, you can set the cooling fan to activate when the camcorder’s internal temperature
reaches a predetermined level.
61
Operating modes:
1 Open the [Fan] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Fan]
[w Other Functions]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
[Fan]
[On]
Options
[On]:
The cooling fan is active at all times regardless of the camera’s
internal temperature.
[Automatic]: When the camcorder’s internal temperature is below a predetermined
level, the cooling fan will not activate. When the internal temperature
reaches the predetermined level, a message will appear and the cooling
fan will activate automatically (
will appear on the screen).
NOTES
• During 4K and 2K modes, when the cooling fan is set to [Automatic] and the camera has cooled down, the
cooling fan will activate in approximately 10 minutes, based on a surrounding temperature of 25 °C (77 °F).
Also, depending on the surrounding temperature, the coolinfan may stop after a short period of time or
continue to operate.
Video Configuration: Type of Recording, Resolution and Frame Rate
Video Configuration: Type of Recording, Resolution and Frame Rate
Before you shoot, select the type of recording, resolution (frame size), frame rate and other settings that best
match your creative needs. The options available will depend on whether the camera is in 4K mode, 2K mode or
MXF mode, as well as the system frequency setting.
62
Selecting the Video Configuration for 4K and 2K Modes
To set the video configuration, select the system frequency, system priority, recording mode, resolution, and
frame rate, as necessary. For a summary of the video configuration, refer to the table following the procedures
below.
Operating modes:
Selecting the System Priority
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[System Priority]
[4K]
When you select the system priority, you can have the camera output 4K
or 2K image data.
1 Open the [System Priority] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [System Priority]
2 Select [4K] or [2K] and then press SET.
• The camera will switch to the selected mode. If the camera was in
MXF mode, it will restart in the selected mode.
Selecting the System Frequency
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[System Frequency]
1 Open the [System Frequency] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [System Frequency]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
• The camera will restart in the selected mode.
[59.94 Hz] or [50.00 Hz]*
• In this manual, recordings with a system frequency of 59.94 Hz,
50.00 Hz and 24.00 Hz are referred to as 59.94 Hz recordings,
50.00 Hz recordings and 24.00 Hz recordings, respectively.
* Depending on the country/region
of purchase.
Selecting the Recording Mode
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[4K (4096/3840)]
[Mode]
For 4K mode, the recording mode determines whether the vertical
resolution is 2160 pixels (RAW) or 1080 pixels (HRAW). For 2K mode, it
determines the color sampling and bit depth.
1 Open the [Mode] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [4K (4096/3840)] or [2K (2048/1920)] >
[Mode]
[RAW]
Video Configuration: Type of Recording, Resolution and Frame Rate
2 Select the desired recording mode and then press SET.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[2K (2048/1920)]
[Mode]
Available recording modes by system priority
System priority Recording mode
Description
63
Standard recording mode for 4K clips. This recording mode
features a 10-bit bit depth and should be used if you plan to
develop the clip using the Cinema RAW Development
software.
RAW
[
12-bit]
4K
Recording mode for use with slow & fast motion recording
from 62 to 120P (for 59.94 Hz recordings) or 52 to 100P (for
50.00 Hz recordings).
HRAW
12-bit Standard recording modes for 2K clips. These recording
modes use the RGB color space, 4:4:4 color sampling, and
have a 12-bit or 10-bit bit depth. High image quality than
10-bit mode.
10-bit
Recording mode for use with slow & fast motion recording
from 62 to 120P (for 59.94 Hz recordings) or 52 to 100P (for
50.00 Hz recordings). This recording mode uses the YCC
color space, 4:2:2 color sampling, and has a 10-bit bit
depth.
2K
10-bit
NOTES
• During slow & fast motion recording, when you wo set the shooting frame rate to 1 to 60P (for 59.94 Hz
recordings) or 1 to 50P (for 50.00 Hz recordings), we recommend you set [Mode] to [RAW], [ 12-bit] or
10-bit].
[
Selecting the Resolution
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
1 Open the [Resolution] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [4K (4096/3840)] or [2K (2048/1920)] >
[4K (4096/3840)]
[Resolution]
[Resolution]
2 Select the desired resolution and then press SET.
• During 4K mode when the recording mode is set to [RAW], available
resolution options are [4096x2160] and [3840x2160]. When the
recording mode is set to [HRAW], available resolution options are
[4096x1080] and [3840x1080].
[4096x2160]
• During 2K mode, available resolution levels are [2048x1080] and
[1920x1080].
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[2K (2048/1920)]
[Resolution]
[2048x1080]
Video Configuration: Type of Recording, Resolution and Frame Rate
Selecting the Frame Rate
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
This procedure is not necessary for 24.00 Hz recordings because the
frame rate will automatically be set to [24.00P].
[4K (4096/3840)]
[2K (2048/1920)]
1 Open the [Frame Rate] submenu.
64
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [4K (4096/3840)] or [2K (2048/1920)] >
[Frame Rate]
[Frame Rate]
2 Select the desired frame rate and then press SET.
• The available frame rates depend on the system priority, system
frequency, recording mode and resolution settings.
[23.98] or [25.00P]*
* Depending on the country/region
of purchase.
NOTES
• Onscreen displays representing the mode, resolution and frame rate
that you selected will appear on the upper right of the screen.
• For details on the signal output from the 3G-SDI terminals, refer to Connecting to a 4K- or 2K-Compatible
External Recorder (A 43). For details on the signal output from the other terminals, refer to Video Output
Available system frequency, system priority, recording mode, resolution, and frame rate settings
System frequency ꢀ
59.94 Hz
50.00 Hz
24.00 Hz
System priority
Frame rate ꢁ
59.94P 25.00P
Mode / Resolution ꢁ
23.98P
Ü
–
29.97P
Ü
–
50.00P
Ü
24.00P
Ü
–
RAW / 4096×2160
HRAW/ 4096×1080
RAW / 3840×2160
HRAW/ 3840×1080
12-bit / 2048×1080
10-bit / 2048×1080
10-bit / 2048×1080
12-bit / 1920×1080
10-bit / 1920×1080
10-bit / 1920×1080
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
4K
Ü
–
Ü
–
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
2K
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
Recording MXF Clips on a CF Card During 4K and 2K Modes
While recording on an external recorder in 4K and 2K modes, the camera can simultaneously record an MXF clip
on a CF card inserted in the camera, except during special recording modes. The selected video configuration
for 4K and 2K modes will be converted to HD video and recorded onto the CF card. You can select the video
configuration of the MXF clips that are recorded on the CF card.
Video configuration recorded on CF card
Video configuration for external recording
Video configuration recorded on CF card
System priority
Recording mode
Resolution
Frame rate
59.94P
29.97P
23.98P
50.00P
25.00P
24.00P
59.94P
50.00P
Bit rate / Resolution
Frame rate
29.97P
50 Mbps / 1920x1080
35 Mbps / 1920x1080
25 Mbps / 1440x1080
23.98P
4096×2160
3840×2160
RAW
4K
25.00P
50 Mbps / 1920x1080
24.00P
59.94P
50.00P
4096×1080
3840×1080
50 Mbps / 1280x720
35 Mbps / 1280x720
HRAW
Video Configuration: Type of Recording, Resolution and Frame Rate
Video configuration for external recording
Video configuration recorded on CF card
System priority
Recording mode
Resolution
Frame rate
59.94P
29.97P
23.98P
50.00P
25.00P
24.00P
59.94P
50.00P
Bit rate / Resolution
Frame rate
29.97P
50 Mbps / 1920x1080
35 Mbps / 1920x1080
25 Mbps / 1440x1080
65
23.98P
12-bit
10-bit
2048×1080
1920×1080
2K
25.00P
50 Mbps / 1920x1080
24.00P
59.94P
50.00P
2048×1080
1920×1080
50 Mbps / 1280x720
35 Mbps / 1280x720
10-bit
Selecting the Resizing Method When Converting to HD Video
When converting 4K or 2K image data with a resolution of 4096x2160, 4096x1080 or 2048x1080 to MXF video
with a resolution of 1920x1080, you can select how it will be recorded on a CF card or output from the HD/SD
SDI terminal, HDMI OUT terminal and SYNC OUT terminal (only when [HD-Y] is selected).
1 Open the [Resize MXF Output] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[Resize MXF Output]
[Letterbox]
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Resize MXF Output]
2 Select [Letterbox], [Squeeze] or [Side Crop] and then press SET.
• The options are the same as those listed for Selecting the Resizing
NOTES
• If you set an assignable button to [Resize MXF Out] (A 111), you can press the button to switch the
resizing method.
• During 4K and 2K modes, the picture output from the 3G-SDI terminals and the picture recorded on a CF card
will differ in image quality due to differences in the signal processing algorithm.
• Because the camera uses a simple resize conversion process vertically, diagonal lines may appear jagged.
Selecting the Video Configuration for MXF Mode
To set the video configuration, select the system frequency, system priority, bit rate and resolution, and frame
rate, as necessary. For a summary of the video configuration, refer to the table following the procedures below.
Operating modes:
Selecting the System Priority
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[System Priority]
[4K]
1 Open the [System Priority] submenu.
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [System Priority]
[
2 Select [MXF] and then press SET.
• The camera will restart in MXF mode.
Video Configuration: Type of Recording, Resolution and Frame Rate
Selecting the System Frequency
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[System Frequency]
1 Open the [System Frequency] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [System Frequency]
2 Select a desired option and then press SET.
• The camera will restart in the selected mode.
66
[59.94 Hz] or [50.00 Hz]*
* Depending on the country/region
of purchase.
Selecting the Bit Rate and Resolution
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[MXF]
1 Open the [Bit Rate/Resolution] submenu to set the bit rate and
resolution.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [MXF] > [Bit Rate/Resolution]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
[Bit Rate/Resolution]
• The selected bit rate and resolution will appear on the upper right of
the screen.
[50 Mbps 1920x1080]
Selecting the Frame Rate
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[MXF]
This procedure is not necessary for 24.00 Hz recordings.
1 Open the [Frame Rate] submenu to set the frame rate.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [MXF] > [Frame Rate]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
[Frame Rate]
• The selected frame rate will appear on the upper rght of the screen.
[59.94i] or [50.00i]*
NOTES
• A single CF card cannot be used to record clips with different system
frequencies (59.94 Hz/50.00 Hz/24.00 Hz).
* Depending on the country/region
of purchase.
Available bit rate, resolution and frame rate settings
System frequency ꢀ
59.94 Hz
50.00 Hz
24.00 Hz
*
Bit rate
Frame rate ꢁ
Resolution ꢁ
59.94i
Ü
–
59.94P
29.97P
Ü
23.98P
50.00i
Ü
–
50.00P
25.00P
Ü
24.00P
1920×1080
1280×720
1920×1080
1280×720
–
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
–
50 Mbps
(CBR 4:2:2)
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
35 Mbps
(VBR 4:2:0)
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
25 Mbps
(CBR 4:2:0)
1440×1080
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
–
* The first line indicates the bit rate (in Mbps); the second line indicates in parentheses whether the bit rate is constant (CBR) or
variable (VBR), and the color sampling. The recordings have 8-bit bit depth.
Changing Main Camera Functions with the FUNC. Button
Changing Main Camera Functions with the FUNC. Button
You can adjust three main camera functions –shutter speed, white balance and ISO speed/gain– using the
FUNC. button (direct setting mode). In direct setting mode, you can change settings using the LCD screen/
viewfinder or using only the rear panel, which is convenient when the monitor unit is not attached to the camera.
This section will explain the basic operation of the direct setting mode. For specific details about the functions
please refer to the each function’s section: shutter speed (A 68), white balance (A 76), ISO speed/gain
67
Operating modes:
Using the Direct Setting Mode
1 Press the FUNC. button.
• On the screen: The onscreen display of the function to be adjusted
will be highlighted in orange.
On the rear panel: Only the icon (white balance) or value (ISO
speed, gain, shutter speed) of the function to be adjusted will be
displayed.
• Repeatedly pressing the FUNC. button will change the function to
be adjusted in the following order: White balance ꢀ ISO speed/gain
ꢀ Shutter speed ꢀ Direct setting mode off.
2 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT ial o select the
desired value (ISO speed, gain, shutter speeddesired white balance mode and then press SET.
• The selected value will be set and the camera will exit the direct setting mode.
• On the screen: The onscreen display of the selected function will return to normal.
On the rear panel: The display will return to normal (all displays will reappear).
• Depending on the function selected, additional adjustment may be possible or necessary before pressing
SET.
NOTES
• The camera will automatically end the direct setting mode in the following cases.
- If no operation was performed for more than 6 seconds.
- If the aperture was adjusted or the ND filter setting was changed.
- If the menu, custom picture menu or a status screen was opened.
- If the control dial’s function is set to [ISO/Gain] and you operate the control dial while adjusting the white
balance or shutter speed in direct setting mode.
• If you set an assignable button to [FUNC.] (A 111), you can press that button instead of the FUNC. button to
enter the direct setting mode.
Shutter Speed
Shutter Speed
Set the shutter speed based on the recording conditions. For example, you may want to set slower shutter
speeds in darker environments. The camera offers the following 5 modes.
68
Operating modes:
[Speed]: Allows you to set the shutter speed (in fractions of a second). You can select the increment to use when
adjusting the shutter speed between 1/3-stop and 1/4-stop increments.
[Angle]: You can set the shutter angle to determine the shutter speed.
[Clear Scan]: Set the frequency in order to record CRT computer monitors without displaying black bands or
flicker on the screen.
[Slow]: You can set slower shutter speeds to obtain brighter recordings in places with insufficient lighting. This
mode is not available during slow & fast motion recording mode.
[Off]: The camera uses a standard shutter speed based on the frame rate.
Available Shutter Speeds
The available shutter speeds vary depending on the frame rate.
Frame rate (59.94 Hz and 24.00 Hz recordings)
Shutter speed mode
59.94i / 59.94P
9.97P
23.98P / 24.00P
1
Off
Speed
1/60
1/60, 1/80, 1/100, 1/125, 1/160, 1/200, 1/31/41/50, 1/60, 1/80, 1/100, 1/25, 1/30, 1/40, 1/50, 1/60, 1/80,
increments 1/250, 1/320, 1/400, 1/500, 1/640, 1//160, 1/200, 1/250, 1/320, 1/100, 1/125, 1/160, 1/200, 1/250,
1/800, 1/1000, 1/1250, 1/1600, 1/200 1/400, 1/500, 1/640, 1/800, 1/1000, 1/320, 1/400, 1/500, 1/640, 1/800,
1/1250, 1/1600, 1/2000 1/1000, 1/1250, 1/1600, 1/2000
1/60, 1/75, 1/90, 1/100, 1/120, 1/150, 1/30, 1/34, 1/40, 1/48, 1/60, 1/75, 1/90, 1/24, 1/30, 1/34, 1/40, 1/48, 1/60, 1/75,
1/30
1/24
1,2
1/3-stop
1/4-stop
increments 1/180, 1/210, 1/250, 1/300, 1/360,
1/420, 1/500, 1/600, 1/720, 1/840,
1/1000, 1/1200, 1/1400, 1/1700,
1/2000
1/100, 1/120, 1/150, 1/180, 1/210, 1/250, 1/90, 1/100, 1/120, 1/150, 1/180, 1/210,
1/300, 1/360, 1/420, 1/500, 1/600, 1/720, 1/250, 1/300, 1/360, 1/420, 1/500, 1/600,
1/840, 1/1000, 1/1200, 1/1400, 1/1700, 1/720,1/840, 1/1000, 1/1200, 1/1400,
1/2000
1/1700, 1/2000
1
Angle
360°, 240°, 216°, 180°, 120°, 90°, 360°, 240°, 216°, 180°, 120°, 108°, 360°, 345.6°, 288°, 240°, 180°,
60°, 45°, 30°, 22.5°, 15°, 11.25°
90°, 60°, 45°, 30°, 22.5°, 15°,
11.25°
172.8°, 144°, 120°, 90°, 86.4°, 72°,
60°, 45°, 30°, 22.5°, 15°, 11.25°
23.98 Hz or 24.00 Hz to 250.27 Hz
1/3, 1/6, 1/12
1
Clear Scan
59.94 Hz to 250.27 Hz
1/4, 1/8, 1/15, 1/30
29.97Hz to 250.27 Hz
1/4, 1/8, 1/15
3
Slow
Frame rate (50.00 Hz recordings)
1/25
Shutter speed mode
50.00i / 50.00P
1/50
25.00P
1
Off
1,2
Speed
1/3-stop
1/50, 1/60, 1/80, 1/100, 1/125, 1/160, 1/200, 1/250, 1/320, 1/25, 1/30, 1/40, 1/50, 1/60, 1/80, 1/100, 1/125, 1/160,
increments 1/400, 1/500, 1/640, 1/800, 1/1000, 1/1250, 1/1600,
1/2000
1/200, 1/250, 1/320, 1/400, 1/500, 1/640, 1/800, 1/1000,
1/1250, 1/1600, 1/2000
1/4-stop
1/50, 1/60, 1/75, 1/90, 1/100, 1/120, 1/150, 1/180, 1/210,
1/25, 1/29, 1/33, 1/40, 1/50, 1/60, 1/75, 1/90, 1/100, 1/120,
1/150, 1/180, 1/210, 1/250, 1/300, 1/350, 1/400, 1/500, 1/600,
1/700, 1/800, 1/1000, 1/1200, 1/1400, 1/1600, 1/2000
increments 1/250, 1/300, 1/350, 1/400, 1/500, 1/600, 1/700, 1/800,
1/1000, 1/1200, 1/1400, 1/1600, 1/2000
1
Angle
360°, 300°, 240°, 180°, 150°, 120°, 90°, 60°, 45°, 30°, 360°, 300°, 240°, 180°, 150°, 120°, 90°, 75°, 60°, 45°,
22.5°, 15°, 11.25°
50.00 Hz to 250.78 Hz
1/3, 1/6, 1/12, 1/25
30°, 22.5°, 15°, 11.25°
25.00 Hz to 250.78 Hz
1/3, 1/6, 1/12
1
Clear Scan
3
Slow
1
2
3
During slow & fast motion recording mode, available values will vary depending on the selected shooting frame rate.
In the Wi-Fi Remote application, all shutter speeds (1/3-stop and 1/4-stop increments) will be available from the same list.
Not available during slow & fast motion recording mode.
Shutter Speed
Changing the Shutter Speed Mode and Value
1 Open the shutter [Mode] submenu.
[~ Camera Setup] > [Shutter] > [Mode]
[~ Camera Setup]
69
2 Select the desired mode and then press SET.
• If you selected [Speed] you can select the increment scale to use
when adjusting the shutter speed; otherwise, skip to step 5.
[Shutter]
[Mode]
[Angle]
3 Open the [Shutter Increment] submenu.
[~ Camera Setup] > [Shutter] > [Shutter Increment]
4 Select [1/3 stop] or [1/4 stop] and then press SET.
5 Adjust the shutter speed, angle value or clear scan frequency
using the direct setting mode.
• Repeatedly press the FUNC. button to highlight the shutter speed
display, select the desired value and then press SET. For details refer
[~ Camera Setup]
[Shutter]
[Shutter Increment]
[1/4 stop]
NOTES
press the button to enter the direct setting mode with the shutter speed
highlighted and ready to be adjusted.
Remote Operation Using Wi-Fi Remote
After completing the necessary preparations (A 51) you can adjust the shutter speed remotely from a Wi-Fi-
enabled device using the Wi-Fi Remote application.
1 Press [ANGLE] on the Wi-Fi Remote screen.
2 Select the desired mode.
3 Press the current shutter speed, angle value or clear scan frequency and select the desired value
from the list.
• You may need to scroll up/down to see all the available values.
• The selected value will be displayed on the Wi-Fi Remote screen and will be applied on the camera.
Shutter Speed
Using Slow Shutter Mode
When recording in dark surroundings, you can obtain a brighter picture by using slow shutter mode. You can
also use this mode when you wish to add certain effects to your recordings, such as blurring the background
during panning shots or recording a moving subject with an afterimage trail.
70
• Image quality may not be as good as when using faster shutter speeds in brighter surroundings.
NOTES
• When recording under artificial light sources such as fluorescent, mercury or halogen lamps, the screen may
flicker depending on the shutter speed. To avoid the flicker, set the shutter speed mode to [Speed] and set the
shutter speed to 1/50* or 1/100 (or an equivalent shutter speed in angle mode).
* May not be available depending on the frame rate.
• Closing down the aperture when recording under bright conditions may cause the picture to appear soft or out
of focus. To avoid the loss of sharpness due to diffraction, use a faster shutter speed, a denser ND filter
• When the shutter speed mode is set to [Slow], bright red, green or blue dots may appear on the screen. In
• Even when using the [C9: EOS Std.] preset custom picture file, if you set the camera to a certain shutter
speed, you may not get the exactly the same image brightness as you would on an EOS digital SLR camera
set to the same shutter speed.
ISO Speed/Gain
ISO Speed/Gain
Depending on the shooting conditions you may want to adjust the brightness of the image. You can do so by
changing the ISO speed or gain value to adjust the sensitivity of the sensor.
71
Operating modes:
Available ISO speed and gain settings
1-stop increments
320*, 400, 800, <850>**, 1600, 3200, 6400, 12800, 20000*
ISO Speed
Gain
320, 400, 500, 640, 800, <850>**, 1000, 1250, 1600, 2000, 2500, 3200, 4000, 5000, 6400,
8000, 10000, 12800, 16000, 20000
1/3-stop increments
Normal
Fine
-6 dB, -3 dB, 0 dB, 3 dB, 6 dB, 9 dB, 12 dB, 15 dB, 18 dB, 21 dB, 24 dB, 30 dB
0 dB to 24 dB in 0.5 dB increments
* The minimum and maximum ISO speeds are available even when the 1-stop increment scale is selected.
**ISO speed required for a suitable dynamic range for Canon Log gamma. Equivalent to a gain value of 2.5 dB.
Changing the ISO Speed or Gain Value
[~ Camera Setup]
1 Open the ISO Speed/Gain [Select] submenu.
[~ Camera Setup] > [ISO/Gain] > [Select]
[ISO/Gain]
[Select]
[ISO]
2 Select [ISO] or [Gain] and then press SET.
If you selected [ISO] (the default value):
3 Open the [ISO Increment] submenu to select the increment to
use when adjusting the ISO speed.
[~ Camera Setup] > [ISO/Gain] > [ISO Increment]
4 Select [1 stop] or [1/3 stop] and then press SET.
5 Adjust the ISO speed using the direct setting mode.
• Repeatedly press the FUNC. button to highlight the ISO speed
display, select the desired value and then press SET. For details refer
[~ Camera Setup]
[ISO/Gain]
[ISO Increment]
[1/3 stop]
If you selected [Gain]:
3 Open the [Gain] submenu to select the increment to use when
adjusting the gain.
[~ Camera Setup] > [ISO/Gain] > [Gain]
[~ Camera Setup]
[ISO/Gain]
[Gain]
4 Select [Normal] (3-dB increment) or [Fine] (0.5-dB increment) and
then press SET.
5 Adjust the gain using the direct setting mode.
• Repeatedly press the FUNC. button to highlight the gain display,
select the desired value and then press SET. For details refer to Using
[Normal]
NOTES
• If you set an assignable button to [FUNC. ISO/Gain] (A 111), you can press the button to enter the direct
setting mode with the ISO speed/gain highlighted and ready to be adjusted.
ISO Speed/Gain
Using the Control Dial
You can adjust the value of the ISO speed or gain using the control
dial on the camera.
You will need to set the control dial’s function to [ISO/Gain] in advance.
72
Control dial
Assigning ISO Speed/Gain Control to the Control Dial
1 Open the [Control Dial] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Custom Function] > [Control Dial]
2 Select [ISO/Gain] and then press SET.
Changing the ISO Speed or Gain Value
To select whether to change the ISO speed or the gain, perform steps
1 to 4 in the previous procedure. Turn the control dial to set the desired ISO
speed or gain value.
[w Other Functions]
[Custom Function]
[Control Dial]
NOTES
• You can use the [w Other Functions] > [Custom Function] > [Control
you turn the control dial.
2 [Iris], 3 [Off]
Remote Operation Using Wi-Fi Remote
After completing the necessary preparations (A 51) you can adjust the ISO speed/gain remotely from a Wi-Fi-
enabled device using the Wi-Fi Remote application.
1 To change the gain value, press [ISO] and then [Gain] on the Wi-Fi Remote screen.
2 Press the current ISO speed or gain value and select the desired value from the list.
• You may need to scroll up/down to see all the available values.
• The selected value will be displayed on the Wi-Fi Remote screen and will be applied on the camera.
NOTES
• When high ISO speeds or gain levels are set, the picture may flicker slightly. ISO 12800 / 30 dB gain and higher
values in particular, allow you to shoot video with a higher sensitivity but are more prone to the appearance of noise.
• When high ISO speeds or gain levels are set, bright red, green or blue dots may appear on the screen. In such
• When the ISO speed or gain level is changed, some noise may appear momentarily on the screen. Do not
adjust the ISO speed/gain level while recording.
ND Filter
ND Filter
Using the ND filters allows you keep the aperture within an appropriate
range when recording in bright surroundings*.
* Closing down the aperture when recording under bright conditions may cause the
picture to appear soft or out of focus. To avoid the loss of sharpness due to diffraction,
73
Operating modes:
Using the ND Filter
Press the ND FILTER + or - button to select the desired ND filter setting.
• Repeatedly pressing ND FILTER + button will change the ND filter setting in the following order: [ND1 2 stops]
ꢀ [ND2 4 stops] ꢀ [ND3 6 stops] ꢀ ND filter off. (The ND FILTER - button cycles through the settings in
reverse order.)
Remote Operation Using Wi-Fi Remote
remotely from a Wi-Fi-enabled device using the Wi-Fi Remote pplication.
Press [ND +] or [ND -] on the Wi-Fi Remote scre.
• The function is identical to that of the ND FILER + d - buttons on the
camera.
• The selected ND filter setting will be displayed on the Wi-Fi Remote screen and
will be applied on the camera.
NOTES
• Depending on the scene, the color may change when turning the ND filter on/off. Setting a custom white
2 Adjusting the Aperture
2 Adjusting the Aperture
You can affect the brightness of your recordings or change the depth of field by adjusting the aperture. For
example, use a small aperture value for a shallow depth of field that isolates the subject in focus and nicely blurs
the background. Available aperture values will vary depending on the EF lens attached to the camera.
74
Operating modes:
Using the Control Dial
You can adjust the aperture value of most EF lenses using the control
dial on the camera.
By default the control dial’s function is set to aperture control. If it has
been changed, follow the procedure below to set the control dial’s
function to [Iris] in advance.
Control dial
Assigning Aperture Control to the Control Dial
[w Other Functions]
1 Open the [Control Dial] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Custom Function] > [Control Dial]
2 Select [Iris] and then press SET.
[Custom Function]
[Control Dial]
[Iris]
Selecting the Increment Scale to Use When Adjusting the
Aperture
1 Open the [Iris Increment] submenu.
[~ Camera Setup] > [Iris] > [Iris Increment]
2 Select [1/2 stop], [1/3 stop] or [Fine] and then press SET.
[~ Camera Setup]
[Iris]
Changing the Aperture Value
Turn the control dial to adjust the aperture.
• The selected aperture value will appear on the lower left of the screen.
[Iris Increment]
[1/3 stop]
• When [~ Camera Setup] > [Iris] > [Iris Increment] is set to [Fine], the
actual increments will be smaller than 1/3 stop but the onscreen display
will show the closest 1/3-stop aperture value.
NOTES
• You can use the [w Other Functions] > [Custom Function] > [Control Dial Dir.] setting (A 123) to change
the direction of the adjustment when you turn the control dial.
Remote Operation Using Wi-Fi Remote
After completing the necessary preparations (A 51) you can adjust the aperture value remotely from a Wi-Fi-
enabled device using the Wi-Fi Remote application.
2 Adjusting the Aperture
1 Press the current aperture value on the Wi-Fi Remote screen.
2 Select the desired aperture value from the list.
• You may need to scroll up/down to see all the available values.
• Alternatively, you can press IRIS [+] to open the aperture or IRIS [-] to close the aperture in 1/8-stop
increments. (Onscreen displays will show the closest 1/3-stop aperture value.)
75
• The selected value will be displayed on the Wi-Fi Remote screen and will be applied on the lens.
NOTES
• When using an EF lens with no lens contacts, such as Canon Cine Lens, you cannot adjust the aperture
using the camera. Adjust the aperture using the le.
• If you are using an EF lens that can correct the ape value according to the position of the zoom, you can
use the [~ Camera Setup] > [Iris] > [Zoom-Irs Correct.] setting to activate this correction.
White Balance
White Balance
The camera uses an electronic white balance process to calibrate the picture and ensure accurate colors under
different lighting conditions. There are 3 methods of setting the white balance.
76
Custom white balance: You can use a white object to establish the white balance and set it to one of two custom
white balance positions, ÅA or ÅB.
Set color temperature: Allows you to set the color temperature between 2,000 K and 15,000 K.
Preset white balance: Set the white balance to ¼ (daylight, 5,400 K) or É (incandescent lamp, 3,200 K). Preset
white balance settings can be further fine-tuned within a range of -9 to 9.
When recording under fluorescent lights, we recommend setting the custom white balance.
Operating modes:
NOTES
• When recording on a CF card, the [Color Matrix] and [White Balance] custom picture settings (A 120) take
precedence over the white balance settings.
• You can use the [w Other Functions] > [Custom Function] > [Shockless WB] setting (A 123) to make the
transition look smoother when you change the white balance settings.
Setting the White Balance
1 Set the white balance mode using the direct setting mode.
• Press the FUNC. button to highlight the white balance icon and select
the desired white balance mode.
• To apply the setting as it is, press SET. To establish the custom white
balance, fine-tune the preset white balance settings or change the
color temperature, continue the procedure as described below before
pressing SET.
If you selected one of the custom white balance settings ÅA or ÅB:
If a custom white balance has not yet been stored, the custom white
balance icon ÅA or ÅB and default value (5,500 K) will flash slowly.
To establish the custom white balance:
2 Point the camera at a white object so that it fills the whole screen.
• Use the same lighting conditions you plan to use when recording.
3 Press the Å button.
• The Å A or Å B icon will flash quickly.
• Make sure the white object fills the screen until the procedure is completed.
• After the icon stops flashing, the procedure is completed and the camera will exit the direct setting mode.
The setting is retained even if you turn off the camera.
If you selected one of the preset white balance settings, ¼ or É:
You can fine-tune the preset values within a range of -9 to 9.
2 Press the Å button.
• On the screen: The adjustment value 0 will appear next to the white balance icon, highlighted in orange.
On the rear panel: The adjustment value 0 will appear.
White Balance
3 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to change the adjustment value and then press SET.
• The selected adjustment value will be set and the camera will exit the direct setting mode.
• On the screen: The selected adjustment value will appear next to the white balance icon.
On the rear panel: The adjustment value display will disappear and the display will return to normal (all displays
will reappear). The white balance fine-tuning icon Ê will appear to indicate that an adjustment has been made.
77
If you selected the color temperature setting, È:
You can set the color temperature between 2,000 K and 15,000 K in 100 K increments.
2 Press the Å button.
• On the screen: The default color temperature value (5,500 K) will be highlighted in orange.
On the rear panel: The default color temperature value will appear.
3 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to change the color temperature value and then
press SET.
• The selected color temperature will be set and the camera will exit the direct setting mode.
• On the screen: The selected color temperature will appear next to the white balance icon.
On the rear panel: The color temperature value will disappear and the display will return to normal (all
displays will reappear).
NOTES
• If you set an assignable button to [FUNC. WB] (A 111), you can press the button to enter the direct setting
mode with the white balance icon highlighted and ready to be adjusted.
Remote Operation Using Wi-Fi Remote
After completing the necessary preparations (A 51) you can adjust the white balance remotely from a Wi-Fi-
enabled device using the Wi-Fi Remote application.
1 Press [ÅA] on the Wi-Fi Remote screen.
2 Select the desired white balance mode.
If you selected ¼, É or È:
3 Press the adjustment value [Ê 0] (¼, É) or color temperature [5500K] (È) and then select the
desired value from the list.
• You may need to scroll up/down to see all the available values.
White Balance
• The selected value will be displayed on the Wi-Fi Remote screen and will be applied on the camera.
78
White balance fine-tuning
Color temperature
If you selected ÅA or ÅB:
3 Point the camera at a white object so that it fills the whole screen.
• Use the same lighting conditions you plan to use when recording.
• Make sure the white object fills the screen until the procedure is completed.
4 Press [Å].
• If a custom white balance has not yet been stored, [Å] will flash slowly.
• During the procedure, [Å] will flash quickly. When it stops ashing, the procedure is completed and the
setting will be applied on the camera.
NOTES
• Using the custom white balance setting:
- Readjust the custom white balance if you turn the ND filter on/off or when the light source has changed.
- Very rarely and depending on the light source, Å may keep flashing (it will change to a slow flashing). You
can still use the setting even in such case.
Adjusting the Focus
Adjusting the Focus
The camera does not have automatic focus control and focusing is done manually using the focus ring on the
attached lens. Nevertheless, the camera offers focus assistance functions to help you adjust the focus more
accurately.
79
2 only: You can adjust the focus of an attached EF lens remotely using the Wi-Fi Remote application.
Operating modes:
Adjusting the Focus Manually
Turn the focus ring on the attached lens to adjust the focus.
1 If the attached lens is equipped with an automatic focus function, set the lens to manual focus mode
in advance.
• Refer to the instruction manual of the lens used.
2 Turn the focus ring to adjust the focus.
NOTES
• 2 On some EF lenses the focus ring will be disabled when the focus mode switch is set to AF. Be sure to
set the focus mode switch to MF in advance.
2 Remote Operation Using Wi-Fi Remote
After completing the necessary preparations (A 51) you can adjust the focus remotely from a Wi-Fi-enabled
device using the Wi-Fi Remote application.
1 Set the focus mode switch on the EF lens to AF (autofocus) mode.
2 Press one of the focus controls to adjust the focus as necessary.
• Press one of the controls on the [NEAR] side to focus closer or one of the controls on the [FAR] side to focus
farther away.
• There are three levels of adjustment - [ ]/[ ] is the smallest and [ ]/[ ] the largest.
Adjusting the Focus
NOTES
• If the focus mode switch on the EF lens is set to MF, you will not be able control the focus through remote
operation. Depending on the lens used, remote operation may not work correctly.
• If you operate the zoom after focusing, the focus on the subject may be lost.
80
• If you focus manually and then leave the camera with the power turned on, the focus on the subject may be
lost after a while. This possible slight shift in focus is a result of the internal temperature rising in the camera
and lens. Check the focus before resuming shooting.
• While the camera is focusing, do not touch the end of the lens or focus ring while they are moving.
Using the Focus Assistance Functions
In order to focus more accurately, you can use two focus assistance functions – peaking, which creates a clearer
contrast by emphasizing the outlines of the subject, and magnification, which enlarges the image on the screen.
You can use both functions simultaneously for greater effect.
You can also use the [w Other Functions] > [Custom Function] > [F. Assist. B&W] setting (A 123) to switch
the screen to black & white while using the focus assistance functions.
Peaking
[£ LCD/VF Setup]
The camera offers two peaking levels. Peaking is applied to the picture on
the camera’s screen and an external monitor connected to the MON. 1
terminal.
[Select]
(under [Peaking])
1 Press the PEAKING button.
[Peaking 1]
• The peaking icon (J or K) appears at the r center of the
screen and the outlines in the image on the screen will be
emphasized, depending on the focus.
• Press the button again to turn off peaking.
• Alternatively, you can use the [£ LCD/VF Setup] > [Peaking]
setting to turn peaking on and off.
2 Open the [Select] submenu (under [Peaking]) to select the peaking level.
[£ LCD/VF Setup] > [Select] (under [Peaking])
3 Select the desired level and then press SET.
• You can use the [£ LCD/VF Setup] > [Peaking 1] and [Peaking 2]
> [Color], [Gain] and [Frequency] settings to set the color, gain and
frequency of the two peaking levels independently of each other.
However, only [Color] will be applied to an external monitor
connected to the MON. 1 terminal. Perform the following procedure
to adjust the peaking gain on an external monitor.
To adjust the peaking gain on an external monitor
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[MON. 1]
1 Open the [Peaking Gain] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [MON. 1] > [Peaking Gain]
2 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to set the level and
then press SET.
[Peaking Gain]
[10]
Magnification
Magnification is applied to the picture on the camera’s screen and the
image output from the MON. terminals.
Adjusting the Focus
Press the MAGN. button.
• ^ appears at the lower center of the screen and the center of the picture is magnified approximately 2 times*.
• Press the button again to cancel the magnification.
* The magnification that appears on the LCD screen, viewfinder screen and external monitor is different. The magnification also
differs based on the video configuration.
81
NOTES
• Peaking appears on the camera screen and an external monitor connected to the MON. 1 terminal.
Magnification appears on the camera screen and an external monitor connected to the MON.1 or MON. 2
terminal. They will not appear when using the other terminals.
• Peaking/Magnification will not affect recordings made on a CF card.
• When using the camera’s screen to focus:
- The camera features professional video scopes (A 100). You can display the edge monitor to help you
focus even more accurately.
- You can use peaking together with the edge monitor. In such case, The gain and frequency of the peaking
effect will be adjusted automatically according to the gain settings of the edge monitor.
• You can use the [w Other Functions] > [Custom Function] > [Magn. Add. Disp.] setting to activate peaking
and the edge monitor while the picture on the screen is being magnified.
Onscreen Markers and Zebra Patterns
Onscreen Markers and Zebra Patterns
Using onscreen markers allows you to make sure your subject is correctly framed and is within the appropriate
safe area. The zebra patterns help you identify areas that are overexposed. The onscreen displays and zebra
pattern appear on the camera screen and an external monitor connected to the MON. 1 terminal. The onscreen
markers and zebra pattern will not affect recordings made on a CF card or the signal output from the 3G-SDI
and MON. 2 terminals.
82
Operating modes:
Displaying Onscreen Markers
[£ LCD/VF Setup]
The camera offers 5 types of onscreen markers. You can display multiple
onscreen markers simultaneously.
[Markers]
1 Open the [Markers] submenu.
[£ LCD/VF Setup] > [Markers]
[Center]
[Horizontal]
[Grid]
[Safety Zone]
[Aspect Marker]
2 Select a marker you wish to display, select [White] or [Gray] and
then press SET.
• Select [Off] to turn off the selected marker.
• You can display multiple markers simultaneously. Repeat ths step as
necessary.
[Off]
• If you selected [Safety Zone] or [Aspect Marker], tinue to step 3.
Otherwise, you can skip to step 4.
3 Select [Safety Zone Area] or [Aspect Ratio], select the desired option and then press SET.
4 Select [Enable], select [On] and then press SET to enable the onscreen markers.
• All of the selected onscreen markers will be displayed.
• Select [Off] to turn off all onscreen markers.
Options
[Center]:
Displays a small marker that indicates the center of the screen.
[Horizontal]:
[Grid]:
Displays a horizontal line to help you compose level shots.
Displays a grid that allows you to frame your shots correctly (horizontally and vertically).
Displays indicators that show various safe areas, such as the action safe area and text safe area.
Available options for [Safety Zone Area] are [80%], [90%], [92.5%] and [95%].
[Safety Zone]:
[Aspect Marker]: Displays markers that indicate various aspect ratios to help you keep your shot within that area.
Available options for [Aspect Ratio] are [2.35:1], [1.85:1], [1.75:1], [1.66:1], [14:9], [13:9] and [4:3].
Safety zone 80%
Level marker
Aspect guide 4:3
Onscreen Markers and Zebra Patterns
Grid
Center marker
83
NOTES
• If you set an assignable button to [Markers] (A 111), you can press the button to turn the onscreen markers
on and off.
• If you selected [Side Crop] for the [ 4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [MON. 1 & 2] > [Resize Output] setting while
video is output from the MON. 1 terminal:
- The [1.85:1] aspect ratio marker will not be displayed.
- If you select [95%] for [Safety Zone Area], the markers on the left and right side will not be displayed.
Displaying Zebra Patterns
[£ LCD/VF Setup]
The camera has a zebra pattern feature that shows black and white
diagonal stripes over areas that are overexposed. The zea patterns will
not affect your recordings. There are two types of zepatterns and you
can display both simultaneously. Zebra 1 lets you identify areas within a
[Select]
(under [Zebra])
certain range ( 5% of a specified level) while zebra 2 lets you identify
[Zebra 1]
areas that are over a specified level. When you display both
simultaneously and they overlap, only zebra 1 will be displayed in those
areas.
1 Open the zebra pattern [Select] submenu.
[£ LCD/VF Setup] > [Select] (under [Zebra])
2 Select [Zebra 1], [Zebra 2] or [Zebra 1&2] and then press SET.
3 Open the zebra level submenu.
[£ LCD/VF Setup] > [Zebra 1 Level] or [Zebra 2 Level]
4 Select a zebra level and then press SET.
5 Press the ZEBRA button to activate the selected zebra pattern.
• Alternatively, before closing the menu, you can also select [Zebra],
select [On] and then press SET.
NOTES
• You can use the [ 4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [HD/SD Output] > [Zebra HD Output] setting to display the zebra
pattern on an external monitor connected to the HD/SD SDI terminal (HD output only), SYNC OUT terminal
(HD-Y signal output only) or HDMI OUT terminal (HD output only).
Setting the Time Code
Setting the Time Code
While recording, the camera can generate a time code signal and embed it in your recordings. You can have the
camera output the time code signal from the 3G-SDI terminals, MON. terminals, HD/SD SDI terminal or TIME
CODE terminal (A 91). In addition, you can superimpose the time code on video output from the HDMI OUT
terminal or SYNC OUT terminal. While playing back video recorded on a CF card, you can output the time code
on the CF card from the HD/SD SDI terminal or TIME CODE terminal. Additionally, you can superimpose the time
code on the picture from the HDMI OUT terminal or SYNC OUT terminal. For recordings with a frame rate of
29.97P, 59.94i or 59.94P, you can also select between a drop frame and non-drop frame time code.
To synchronize the camera’s time code to an external time code generator, refer to Synchronizing with an
84
Operating modes:
Selecting the Running Mode
[¤ TC/UB Setup]
During MXF mode, you can select the running mode of the camera’s time
code. During 4K and 2K modes, the running mode will be set to [Free
Run] during normal shooting and slow & fast recording mode; it will be set
[Time Code]
to [Rec Run] during interval recording and frame recording modes. You
can set the time code’s initial value, however, by performing the procedure
in the following section Setting the Time Code’s Initial Value.
[Mode]
[Preset]
1 Open the time code [Mode] submenu.
[¤ TC/UB Setup] > [Time Code] > [Mode]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
[¤ TC/UB Setup]
[Time Code]
[Run]
• If you selected [Regen.], you do not need to perform the rest of this
procedure. If you selected [Preset] and would like to set the time
code’s initial value, see the following section Setting the Time Code’s
Initial Value.
3 After you select [Preset], open the time code [Run] submenu.
[¤ TC/UB Setup] > [Time Code] > [Run]
[Free Run]
4 Select the desired option and then press SET.
Options
[Preset]: The time code starts from an initial value you can select in
advance. The default initial time code is 00:00:00.00. The time
code’s running mode depends on the [Run] setting.
[Rec Run]: The time code runs only while recording so clips
recorded consecutively on the same CF card will have
continuous time codes.
[Free Run]:The time code starts running the moment you press
SET to select this option and keeps running regardless
of the camera’s operation.
[Regen.]: The camera will read the selected CF card and the time code will
continue from the last recorded time code on the CF card. The
time code runs only while recording so clips recorded
consecutively on the same CF card will have continuous time
codes.
Setting the Time Code
Setting the Time Code’s Initial Value
[¤ TC/UB Setup]
If you set the time code mode to [Preset], you can set the initial value of
the time code.
[Time Code]
[Setting]
85
1 Open the time code [Setting] submenu.
[¤ TC/UB Setup] > [Time Code] > [Setting]
2 Select [Set] and then press SET.
• The time code setting screen appears with an orange selection frame
indicating the hours.
• To reset the time code to [00:00:00.00], select [Reset] instead. If the running mode is set to [Free Run], the
time code will be reset the moment you press SET and keep running continuously from 00:00:00.00.
3 Use the joystick (Ý) or SELECT dial to set the hours and press SET to move to the minutes.
4 Change the rest of the fields (minutes, seconds, frame) in the same way.
• Press the CANCEL button to close the screen without setting the time code.
5 Select [Set] to close the screen.
• If the running mode is set to [Free Run], the time code will start running from the selected time code the
moment you press SET.
Selecting Drop or Non-Drop Frame
[¤ TC/UB Setup]
When [ 4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [4K (4096/3840)], [2K (2048/1920)] or
[MXF] > [Frame Rate] is set to [59.94P], [59.94i] or [29.9P], you can
select between a drop frame (DF) or non-drop frame NDtime code,
[Time Code]
depending on how you plan to use your recordings.
When [Frame Rate] is set to any other setting, the time code is set to non-
drop frame (NDF) and cannot be changed.
[DF/NDF]
[DF]
1 Open the [DF/NDF] submenu.
[¤ TC/UB Setup] > [Time Code] > [DF/NDF]
2 Select [DF] or [NDF] and then press SET.
• The time code display will differ depending on the setting. When you select [DF], the time code will appear
as [00:00:00.00]; when you select [NDF], it will appear as [00:00:00:00].
Putting the Time Code Display on Hold
If you set an assignable button to [Time Code Hold] (A 111), you can press the button to freeze the display of
the time code*. While the time code display is put on hold, [H] will appear on the screen next to the time code
and [HOLD] will appear on the rear panel.
The time code continues to run normally while the time code display is on hold. When you resume the time code
display, the current time code will be displayed.
* The time code display from the video output terminals will be put on hold. The time code data that is superimposed on the output
from the TIME CODE terminal, 3G-SDI terminals, MON. terminals and HD/SD SDI terminal will not be put on hold.
Setting the Time Code
About the Time Code Display
An icon may appear next to the time code depending on the operation. Refer to the following table.
Icon
R
Description
The time code is set to [Regen.].
86
P
The time code is set to [Preset] and the running mode is set to [Rec Run].
The time code is set to [Preset] and the running mode is set to [Free Run].
Time code signal is coming from an external source.
Time code display is on hold.
F
E
H
No icon Time code during clip playback.
NOTES
• When the frame rate is 23.98P or 24.00P, the frames value in the time code runs from 0 to 23. When the frame
rate is 25.00P, 50.00i or 50.00P, it runs from 0 to 24. For other frame rates, it runs from 0 to 29.
• In 4K and 2K modes or when using pre-recording mode in MXF mode, [Free Run] is set automatically and
cannot be changed. When you are using interval recording, frame recording or slow & fast motion recording
mode, you cannot select the [Free Run] running mode.
• When you mix drop frame and non-drop frame time codes, there might be a discontinuity in the time code at
the point where the recording starts.
• As long as the built-in rechargeable lithium battery is charged and you selected the [Free Run] running mode,
the time code continues to run even if you disconnect all other power sources. However, this is less accurate
than when the camera is on.
Setup] > [Time Code] submenu.
Setting the User Bit
Setting the User Bit
The user bit display can be selected from the date or the time of
recording, or an identification code consisting of 8 characters in the
hexadecimal system. There are sixteen possible characters: the numbers
0 to 9 and the letters A to F.
If user bit information is being received along with an external time code,
you can also record the external user bit on the recording media. The user
bit information can be output from the 3G-SDI terminals, MON. terminals
and HD/SD SDI terminals.
[¤ TC/UB Setup]
87
[User Bit]
[Type]
[Setting]
Operating modes:
1 Open the user bit [Type] submenu.
[¤ TC/UB Setup] > [User Bit] > [Type]
2 Select the desired user bit type and press SET.
• Select [Setting] to set your own identification code, [Time] to use the time as user bit, or [Date] to use the
date as the user bit.
• If you selected [Time] or [Date], you do not need to perform the rest of the procedure. If you selected
[Setting], continue the procedure to set the identification code.
3 Select [Set] and then press SET.
• The user bit setting screen appears with an orange selecton frame on the leftmost digit.
• To reset the user bit to [00 00 00 00], select [Reset] ead.
4 Use the joystick (Ý) or SELECT dial to selece first character and press SET to move to the next
digit.
• Change the rest of the digits in the same way.
• Press the CANCEL button to close the screen without setting the user bit.
5 Select [Set] to close the screen.
Synchronizing with an External Device
Synchronizing with an External Device
Using genlock synchronization, you can synchronize this camera’s video signal to that of an external video
device. Similarly, using an external time code signal, you can synchronize this camera’s time code to the external
signal. Using the external time code signal with multiple cameras allows you to set up a multi-camera recording.
You can also output the time code signal from this camera to achieve the same result. If you output the time
code (while shooting) from the 3G-SDI terminals or HD/SD SDI terminal* to an editing device, the editor can
create video with the same time code.
88
* The HDI-SDI terminal can also output the time code during playback.
Connecting an External Device
When synchronizing the camera to an external signal, input a reference video signal* through the GENLOCK
terminal or output the camera’s signal as a reference signal for an external device through the SYNC OUT terminal.
When synchronizing a time code signal, use the TIME CODE terminal. Be sure to set the TIME CODE terminal to
input or output in advance.
Connect the external device to the camera as shown in the following diagram.
* For the reference video signal, you can use an analog blackburst or tri-level signal.
Connection Diagram
GENLOCK terminal
SYNC OUT terminal
TIME CODE terminal
GENLOCK
Time code
synchronization
synchronization
Reference Video Signal Input (Genlock Synchronization)
When a reference sync signal (analog blackburst or tri-level signal) is input through the GENLOCK terminal, the
phases of the camera’s V and H sync will automatically be synchronized to it. The phase difference between the
external Genlock signal and the camera is initially set to 0. The H phase can be adjusted within the range of
approximately 0.4 H (HD equivalent).
Operating modes:
1 Open the [Genlock Adjust.] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Genlock Adjust.]
[w Other Functions]
2 Adjust the phase to the desired level, select [Set] and then press
SET.
[Genlock Adjust.]
• Use the joystick (Ý) or SELECT dial to select the value for each field
and press SET to move to the next field.
Synchronizing with an External Device
Time Code Signal Input
[¤ TC/UB Setup]
[Time Code]
[TC In/Out]
[In]
An external SMPTE-standard LTC timing signal received from the TIME
CODE terminal will be recorded as the time code. The user bit of the
external timing signal can also be recorded. Before connecting the device,
set the TIME CODE terminal to input. Also, you must set the running
89
Operating modes:
1 Open the [TC In/Out] submenu.
[¤ TC/UB Setup] > [Time Code] > [TC In/Out]
2 Select [In] and then press SET.
Recording the User Bit of an External Signal
[¤ TC/UB Setup]
[User Bit]
The user bit of an external time code signal can also be recorded with the
time code itself.
1 Open the user bit [Rec Mode] submenu.
[¤ TC/UB Setup] > [User Bit] > [Rec Mode]
2 Select [External] and then press SET.
[Rec Mode]
[Internal]
NOTES
• The Genlock signal synchronization stabilizes afteprximately 10 seconds. When the camera locks on an
external Genlock signal, U will appear on he uright of the screen.
• If the external Genlock signal is incorrect or there is no input signal, the external time code that is recorded
may be incorrect.
• While a time code signal is being received, the external time code’s drop-frame bit will be used (if the external
time code is non-drop frame, [NDF] will appear on the rear panel).
• When an external time code signal is received, the camera’s own time code will be synchronized to it and the
synchronization will be maintained even if you disconnect the cable from the TIME CODE terminal. However,
performing any of the following actions while the cable is not connected will cause the synchronization to be
disrupted; the correct time code will be restored once you reconnect the cable.
- Turning the camera off/on
- Changing the operating mode to
- Changing the video configuration
mode
• If the external time code signal is incorrect or there is no input signal, the internal time code set in the
[¤ TC/UB Setup] > [Time Code] submenu will be recorded instead.
• When the camera locks on an external time code signal, [EXT-LOCK] appears on the rear panel.
Synchronizing with an External Device
Reference Video Signal Output
You can output the camera’s video signal as a reference sync signal (analog blackburst or tri-level signal) through
the SYNC OUT terminal to synchronize an external device to this camera.
90
Operating modes:
In
mode, you must first set [¤ TC/UB Setup] > [Time Code]
mode
> [24P TC/Sync] to [Normal], which is the default setting. In
mode or if the default setting has not been changed in
from step 3 below.
mode, start
[¤ TC/UB Setup]
[Time Code]
[24P TC/Sync]
[Normal]
1 Open the [24P TC/SYNC] submenu.
[¤ TC/UB Setup] > [Time Code] > [24P TC/Sync]
2 Select [Normal] and then press SET.
3 Open the [Output] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] (in
mode) or [¢ Video Setup] (in
mode) > [SYNC OUT] > [Output]
mode:
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
4 Select [HD Sync] (tri-level signal) or [Blk Burst]* (black burst) and
then press SET.
[
mode:
[¢ Video Setup]
• If necessary, select [Normal] or [XF Legacy] with the [¤ TC/UB
Setup] > [Time Code] > [24P TC/Sync] setting.
• If necessary, adjust the scan mode with the [ 4K/2K/MXSetup]
> [SYNC OUT] > [Scan Mode] setting.
* Not available for 24.00 Hz recordings.
[SYNC OUT]
[Output]
[Composite]
Synchronization signal summary
Video configuration for recording
SYNC OUT terminal
1
HD Sync
System
priority
Recording
mode
Resolution
Frame rate
Blk Burst
480/59.94i
576/50.00i
2
Normal
XF Legacy
59.94P
29.97P
23.98P
50.00P
25.00P
24.00P
59.94P
50.00P
59.94P
29.97P
23.98P
50.00P
25.00P
24.00P
59.94P
50.00P
1080/29.97 (P/PsF)
1080/23.98 (P/PsF)
1080/25.00 (P/PsF)
1080/59.94i
4096×2160
3840×2160
RAW
4K
1080/50.00i
1080/24.00 (P/PsF)
720/59.94P
1080/60.00i
720/59.94P
720/50.00P
–
480/59.94i
576/50.00i
4096×1080
3840×1080
HRAW
720/50.00P
1080/29.97 (P/PsF)
1080/23.98 (P/PsF)
1080/25.00 (P/PsF)
1080/59.94i
480/59.94i
12-bit
10-bit
2048×1080
1920×1080
2K
1080/50.00i
576/50.00i
1080/24.00 (P/PsF)
720/59.94P
1080/60.00i
720/59.94P
720/50.00P
–
480/59.94i
576/50.00i
2048×1080
1920×1080
10-bit
720/50.00P
Synchronizing with an External Device
Video configuration
Resolution
SYNC OUT terminal
1
HD Sync
mode
System priority
Frame rate
Blk Burst
mode
2
Normal
XF Legacy
91
59.94i
29.97P
23.98P
50.00i
1080/59.94i
1080/29.97 (P/PsF)
1080/23.98 (P/PsF)
1080/50.00i
1080/59.94i
1080/59.94i
480/59.94i
1920×1080
1080/50.00i
1080/60.00i
1080/50.00i
1080/60.00i
576/50.00i
–
25.00P
24.00P
59.94P
29.97P
23.98P
50.00P
25.00P
24.00P
1080/25.00 (P/PsF)
1080/24.00 (P/PsF)
720/59.94P
MXF
720/29.97P
720/59.94P
720/59.94P
480/59.94i
720/23.98P
1280×720
720/50.00P
720/50.00P
720/60.00P
720/50.00P
720/60.00P
576/50.00i
–
720/25.00P
720/24.00P
1
2
You can use the [¤ TC/UB Setup ] > [Time Code] > [24P TC/Sync] setting to select [Normal] or [XF Legacy].
You can switch between the P and PsF setting for output.
Time Code Signal Output
The time code will be output from the TIME CODE tnal as an SMPTE-standard LTC timing signal. The user
bit will also be output. Before connecting the device, set [¤ TC/UB Setup] > [Time Code] > [TC In/Out] to
[Out] to change the TIME CODE terminal to output (A 89). The embedded time code will be output from the
3G-SDI terminals, MON. terminals and HD/SD SDI terminal.
Operating modes:
NOTES
• The user bit of the time code signal is output while the camera is recording in
mode or during playback
of a clip recorded on a CF card in mode. For the HD/SD SDI terminal, when the frame rate is set to
[23.98P] and the [¤ TC/UB Setup] > [User Bit] > [Output Mode] setting is set to [Pulldown], the user bit
will be 2:3 pulldown data. In other words, when a 23.98P recording is output from the HD/SD SDI terminal, the
signal is converted to 59.94i using the 2:3 pulldown method. An external device can receive the data used in
this conversion (2:3 pulldown data) to convert the signal to the original 23.98P specifications.
Recording Audio
Recording Audio
The camera features two-channel linear PCM audio recording and playback with a sampling frequency of
48 kHz. You can record audio using commercially available microphones (XLR terminal, MIC terminal) or line
input (XLR terminal). You can select the audio input independently for channel 1 and channel 2.
An audio signal will be output with the video signal from the 3G-SDI terminals, MON. terminals and HD/SD SDI
terminal. When you use an external recorder, the audio signal will also be recorded.
92
Operating modes:
Connecting an External Microphone or External Audio Input Source to the Camera
In order to use the XLR terminals, the monitor unit must be attached to the camera. The monitor unit features
two XLR terminals (CH1/CH2) that can be used to record audio independently to the two audio channels.
In addition to XLR microphones, you can also connect to the camera’s MIC terminal commercially available
condenser microphones with their own power supply and a ∅ 3.5 mm mini-stereo plug*. If the monitor unit is
attached to the camera, you can use the microphone holder on the monitor unit.
* For 50.00 Hz recordings, use commercially available microphones with a cable no longer than 3 m.
Follow the procedure below to attach a microphone (refer also to the following illustration). To connect an
external device to the camera, plug the device’s cable into the camera’s XLR terminal (ብ).
1 Loosen the microphone lock screw (ቢ), open the microhone holder and insert the microphone (ባ).
2 Tighten the lock screw and put the microphonabe through the microphone cable clamp under
the microphone holder (ቤ).
3 Plug the microphone cable into the desired XLR terminal (ብ) or the MIC terminal (ቦ).
XLR terminals
Cable clamp
MIC terminal
Microphone
lock screw
NOTES
• Be careful not to pass the microphone cable in front of the cooling fan’s air vents. Failure to do so may cause
audio noise to be recorded.
Recording Audio
Selecting the Audio Input from the XLR Terminals
Using the XLR terminals CH1 and CH2, you can record audio independently to the two audio channels from a
microphone or analog audio input source. Note that the camera’s MIC terminal is given priority over the XLR
terminals. To record audio from the XLR terminals, be sure not to connect any microphones to the MIC terminal.
93
Switching Between Microphone and Line Input
CH1/CH2
ã
switches
Set the XLR terminal switch of the desired channel to LINE or MIC.
• To supply a microphone with phantom power, set the switch to
MIC+48V instead. Make sure to connect the microphone first, before
turning the phantom power on. Keep the microphone connected
when turning off the phantom power.
XLR
terminal
switches
• When using the XLR terminal to record to only one channel, use the
CH1 terminal.
CH1/CH2
ã
dials
Selecting the Recording Channel
[¡ Audio Setup]
You can select to which channel the camera will recaudio.
1 Open the [XLR Rec Channel] submenu.
[Audio Input]
[XLR Rec Channel]
[CH1]
[¡ Audio Setup] > [Audio Input] > [XLR Rec Channel]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
Options
[CH1]:
Records audio to each channel separately. Audio input
into CH1 is recorded to channel 1, while audio input into
CH2 is recorded to channel 2.
[CH1/CH2]: Audio input into CH1 is recorded to both channels. Audio
input into CH2 will not be recorded.
IMPORTANT
• When connecting a microphone or device that does not support phantom power, make sure to set the XLR
terminal switch to MIC or LINE, respectively. If you set the switch to MIC+48V, the microphone or device may
be damaged.
Recording Audio
Adjusting the Audio Level from the XLR Terminals
You can set the audio recording level for audio input from the XLR terminals to auto or manual for each channel.
94
Automatic Audio Level Adjustment
Set the ã switch of the desired channel to A (automatic) to let
the camera automatically adjust that channel’s audio level.
NOTES
• When both CH1 and CH2 are set to the same audio input (external
microphone or external line input), if the audio level is set to automatic,
you can use the [¡ Audio Setup] > [Audio Input] > [XLR ALC Link]
setting to link the audio level adjustment of both channels.
CH1/CH2
ã
switches
CH1/CH2
ã
Manual Audio Level Adjustment
switches
You can set the audio level for each channel manually from -G to 18 dB.
1 Set the ã switch of the desired channel to M.
2 Turn the corresponding ã dial to adjust the audio level.
• For reference, the 0 corresponds to -G, 5 corresponds to 0 dB,
and 10 corresponds to +18 dB.
• As a guideline, adjust the audio recording level so that e audio level
meter on the screen or rear panel will go to the rof the 18 dB
mark (one mark right of the 20 dB mark) ony occasionally.
CH1/CH2
ã
dials
• Closing the protective cover for XLR audio controls will prevent the
audio controls from being changed inadvertently.
NOTES
• If at least one of the channels is set to manual audio level adjustment, you can also activate the audio peak
limiter to prevent audio distortions. When activated, the audio peak limiter will limit the amplitude of audio input
signals when they exceed -4 dBFS. Use the [¡ Audio Setup] > [Audio Input] > [Limiter] setting.
• We recommend using headphones when adjusting the audio level. If the input level is too high, audio may
become distorted even if the audio level indicator shows an appropriate level.
• If you set an assignable button to [Audio Level] (A 111), you can press the button to turn the onscreen audio
level indicator on and off.
Recording Audio
Adjusting the Microphone’s Sensitivity
[¡ Audio Setup]
You can adjust the microphone’s sensitivity if the XLR terminal switch is
set to MIC or MIC+48V.
[Audio Input]
95
1 Open the desired XLR terminal’s sensitivity submenu.
[¡ Audio Setup] > [Audio Input] > [XLR1 Mic Trimming] or [XLR2
Mic Trimming]
[XLR1 Mic Trimming]
[XLR2 Mic Trimming]
2 Select the desired level and then press SET.
[0 dB]
Available Sensitivity Levels
+12 dB
+6 dB
0 dB
-6 dB
-12 dB
Activating the Microphone’s Attenuator
[¡ Audio Setup]
You can activate the microphone’s attenuator (20 dB) if the XLR terminal
switch is set to MIC or MIC+48V.
[Audio Input]
1 Open the desired XLR terminal’s microphone attenuator submenu.
[¡ Audio Setup] > [Audio Input] > [XLR1 Mic Att.] or
[XLR2 Mic Att.]
[XLR1 Mic Att.]
[XLR2 Mic Att.]
2 Select [On] and then press SET.
[Off]
Adjusting the Audio Level from the MIC minal
You can adjust the audio recording level of a microphone attached to the
MIC terminal to auto or manual. You can set the audio level manually
within a range of 0 to 99.
[¡ Audio Setup]
[Audio Input]
[MIC Mode]
1 Open the [MIC Mode] submenu.
[¡ Audio Setup] > [Audio Input] > [MIC Mode]
2 Select [Automatic] or [Manual] and then press SET.
• If you selected [Automatic], you do not need to perform the rest of the
procedure. If you selected [Manual], continue the procedure to set the
microphone’s audio recording level.
[Automatic]
3 Open the [MIC Level] submenu.
[¡ Audio Setup] > [Audio Input] > [MIC Level]
[¡ Audio Setup]
[Audio Input]
[MIC Level]
[50]
4 Use the joystick (Ý) or SELECT dial to set the audio recording
level and then press SET.
• As a guideline, adjust the audio recording level so that the audio level
meter on the screen or rear panel will go to the right of the 18 dB
mark (one mark right of the 20 dB mark) only occasionally.
NOTES
• When adjusting the audio level manually, you can activate the audio peak limiter with the [¡ Audio Setup] >
[Audio Input] > [Limiter] setting. When activated, the audio peak limiter will limit the amplitude of audio input
signals when they exceed -6 dBFS.
• We recommend using headphones when adjusting the audio level. If the input level is too high, audio may
become distorted even if the audio level indicator shows an appropriate level.
• If you set an assignable button to [Audio Level] (A 111), you can press the button to turn the onscreen audio
level indicator on and off.
Recording Audio
Activating the Microphone’s Attenuator
[¡ Audio Setup]
[Audio Input]
[MIC Att.]
If the audio level is too high and the sound sounds distorted, activate the
microphone attenuator (20 dB).
96
1 Open the [MIC Att.] submenu.
[¡ Audio Setup] > [Audio Input] > [MIC Att.]
2 Select [On] and then press SET.
[Off]
Monitoring the Audio with Headphones
Connect headphones* to the × (headphone) terminal to monitor the
recorded audio. You can adjust the headphone volume with the
[¡ Audio Setup] > [Audio Output] > [Headphone Volume] setting.
* For 50.00 Hz recordings, use commercially available headphones with a cable no
longer than 3 m.
Selecting the Audio Channel
You can select the audio channel that is output from the ×
(headphone) terminal.
Operating modes:
× (headphone)
terminal
1 Open the [Channel] submenu.
[¡ Audio Setup]
[Audio Output]
[Channel]
[¡ Audio Setup] > [Audio Output] > [Channel]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
Options
[CH1/CH2]: Audio from CH1 is output from the left audio channel and
audio from CH2 is output from the right audio channel.
[CH1/CH1]: Audio from CH1 is output from both the left and right audio
channels.
[CH1/CH2]
[CH2/CH2]: Audio from CH2 is output from both the left and right audio
channels.
[All/All]:
Audio from CH1 and CH2 is mixed and output from both
the left and right audio channels.
NOTES
• If you set an assignable button to [Audio Output CH] (A 111), you can press the button to change the audio
channel directly.
Using Metadata
Using Metadata
The camera automatically adds metadata to MXF clips, which are recorded on a CF card. You can use the
supplied Canon XF Utility software to check and search for specific metadata. You can also create and transfer
97
Metadata Components
Entering content
Canon XF Utility
Checking content
Metadata
Camera
Wi-Fi Remote
Canon XF Utility
1
User Memo: clip title, creator, location and description.
GPS information: altitude, latitude and longitude.
–
–
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
Ü
2
Ü
3
Recording data: Shutter speed, ISO speed/gain value, etc.
–
–
Unique Material Identifiers (UMID): country, organization
and user codes based on the SMPTE standard.
Ü
–
–
–
1
2
3
User memo files need to be created using the software and saved on the SD card in advance.
GPS information can only be added to clips already recorded.
Recording data is logged automatically by the camera.
Operating modes:
Setting a User Memo Created with Canon XUtility
Before you can add a user memo, you must first inshe supplied Canon XF Utility software (A 152). Next,
create the user memo and then save it to an SD card. Once you insert the SD card in the camera and select the
user memo, it will be added to clips you record.
For details on using the supplied software, refer to the instruction manual that is installed with the Canon XF
1 Use Canon XF Utility to save a user memo to an SD card.
• For details, refer to Managing User Memo Profiles in the Canon XF Utility Instruction Manual.
2 Insert the SD card into the SD card slot of the camera.
3 Open the metadata [Setting] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[Metadata]
[Setting]
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Metadata] > [Setting]
4 Select [SD Card] and then press SET.
5 Open the [User Memo] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Metadata] > [User Memo]
6 Select the file name of the desired user memo and then press SET.
• The Q icon appears on the right of the screen.
[SD Card]
• Select [Off] to record clips without a user memo.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[Metadata]
NOTES
• After you set a user memo, do not remove the SD card while you are
recording. If the SD card is removed, the user memo will not be added
to the clip.
[User Memo]
• You must set the user memo before you start recording for it to be
added to the clip. You cannot change the user memo already added to a
clip using the camera but you can do so with the Canon XF Utility
software.
Using Metadata
Setting a User Memo Using Wi-Fi Remote
After completing the necessary preparations (A 51) you create a user memo profile and transfer it to the
camera from a Wi-Fi-enabled device using the Wi-Fi Remote application. Using the Wi-Fi Remote application
you have two additional advantages over user memos created with Canon XF Utility: you can change the user
memo of the last clip recorded, even if you did not specify a user memo in advance; and you can enter manually
the GPS information of your shooting location.
98
1 Press the [Metadata Input] tab on the Wi-Fi Remote screen.
2 Press [— Activate].
• Alternatively, on the camera, you can set [ 4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Metadata] > [Setting] to [Remote].
3 Fill the necessary user memo and GPS information fields.
• You can press [Clear] to clear the information entered into each field.
4 Press one of the transfer options to transfer the metadata to the camera.
• [Metadata correctly transferred] will be displayed on the Wi-Fi Remote screen and the metadata will be
transferred and applied to the clips on the camera.
5 Press ^ to close the message.
Options
[Apply from Next]: Adds the metadata you set in Wi-Fi Remote to all clips recorded after the transfer.
[Overwrite Prev.]: Only available after recording a clip. Adds the metadata you set in Wi-Fi Remote to all clips recorded
after the transfer and also to the last clip recorded (overwriting any user memo that may have been
recorded previously with the clip).
[Overwrite]:
Only available while recording a clip. Adde metadata you set in Wi-Fi Remote to the clip that is
being recorded (overwriting any preuser memo). It will also add this metadata to all clips
recorded after the transfer.
NOTES
• The metadata sent to the camera from Wi-Fi Remote will be lost in the following cases.
- If the camera was turned off.
- If the [ 4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Metadata] > [Setting] setting was changed.
• Metadata sent to the camera from Wi-Fi Remote will not be added to relay clips recorded before the switch to
the current CF card.
Color Bars/Audio Reference Signal
Color Bars/Audio Reference Signal
You can have the camera generate and record color bars and/or a 1 kHz audio reference signal and output them
1
1
2
from the 3G-SDI terminals , MON. terminals , HD/SD SDI terminal, HDMI OUT terminal, SYNC OUT terminal
1
and × (headphone) terminal .
Outputs audio reference signal only.
99
1
2
Outputs color bars only.
Operating modes:
Recording Color Bars
[~ Camera Setup]
You can choose between SMPTE standard-definition color bars, EBU
color bars and ARIB multi-format HDTV color bars.
[Color Bars]
1 Open the color bars [Type] submenu.
[~ Camera Setup] > [Color Bars] > [Type]
[Type]
2 Select the type of color bars and then press SET.
[SMPTE]
3 Open the [Enable] submenu to activate the color bars.
[~ Camera Setup] > [Color Bars] > [Enable]
4 Select [On] and then press SET.
• The selected color bars appear on the screen and wbe recorded
[~ Camera Setup]
when you press the START/STOP button.
[Color Bars]
• Turning the camera off or changing the operatinode to
mode will deactivate the color bars.
[Enable]
you can press the button to activate the color bars.
[Off]
Recording an Audio Reference Signal
[¡ Audio Setup]
The camera can output a 1 kHz audio reference signal with the color bars.
[Audio Input]
[1 kHz Tone]
[Off]
1 Open the [1 kHz Tone] submenu.
[¡ Audio Setup] > [Audio Input] > [1 kHz Tone]
2 Select the desired level and then press SET.
• Available levels are -12 dB, -18 dB and -20 dB.
• Select [Off] to turn off the signal.
• The signal is output at the selected level and will be recorded when
you press the START/STOP button.
Video Scopes
Video Scopes
The camera can display a simplified waveform monitor or vectorscope. It can also display an edge monitor* to
help you focus. The video scopes appear only on the LCD screen. They do not appear in the viewfinder or on an
external monitor. In order to use the video scopes, the monitor unit must be attached to the camera.
* The edge monitor looks at the focus of the entire picture and displays the results as a waveform. The edge monitor is available
100
only in
mode.
Operating modes:
Displaying a Video Scope
Press the WFM button (waveform monitor or vectorscope) or EDGE
MON. button (edge monitor).
• The waveform monitor will appear in a window on the lower right of the
screen.
• You can repeatedly press the WFM button to activate the video scopes
in the following sequence.
Waveform monitor ꢀ Vectorscope ꢀ Off
• Alternatively, you can display the video scopes using [w Other
Functions] > [WFM (LCD)] > [Setting]. Select [WFM] for the waveform
monitor, [VS] for the vectorscope or [Edge Mon.] for the edge monitor.
Configuring the Waveform Monitor
[w Other Functions]
[WFM (LCD)]
The camera’s waveform monitor function offers 5 modes. You can also
change the gain.
1 Open the [Waveform Monitor] submenu.
[Waveform Monitor]
[Line]
[w Other Functions] > [WFM (LCD)] > [Waveform Monitor]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
• If you do not need to change the gain, you do not need to perform
steps 3 and 4.
3 Open the waveform monitor [Gain] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [WFM (LCD)] > [Gain] (under [Waveform Monitor])
4 Select [1x] or [2x] and then press SET.
Options
[Line]:
Sets the waveform monitor to line display mode.
[Line+Spot]:
[Field]:
The waveform of the area in the red frame is displayed in red on top of the [Line] mode waveform.
Sets the waveform monitor to field display mode.
[RGB]:
Functions like an RGB parade scope.
[YPbPr]:
Functions like a YPbPr parade scope.
Video Scopes
Configuring the Vectorscope
[w Other Functions]
The camera’s vectorscope function offers 2 modes. You can also change
the gain.
[WFM (LCD)]
[Vectorscope]
[Normal]
101
1 Open the [Vectorscope] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [WFM (LCD)] > [Vectorscope]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
• If you do not need to change the gain, you do not need to perform
steps 3 and 4.
3 Open the vectorscope [Gain] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [WFM (LCD)] > [Gain] (under [Vectorscope])
4 Select [1x] or [5x] and then press SET.
Options
[Spot]:
The color signal of the area in the red frame is displayed in red on top of the [Normal] mode waveform.
[Normal]: Displays the vectorscope.
Configuring the Edge Monitor
[w Other Functions]
[WFM (LCD)]
[Edge Monitor]
[Type 1]
Using this video scope allows you to focus with more precisio. You can
use the edge monitor along with the other focus assistafunctions
1 Open the [Edge Monitor] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [WFM (LCD)] > [Edge Monitor]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
• If you do not need to change the gain, you do not need to perform
steps 3 and 4.
3 Open the edge monitor [Gain] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [WFM (LCD)] > [Gain] (under [Edge Monitor])
4 Select the desired gain value and then press SET.
Options
[Type 1]: The waveform that represents the focus of the entire picture is displayed in green. In addition, the waveform
of the area in the three red frames is displayed in red on top of the previous waveform.
[Type 2]: This mode displays the edge monitor with the waveform monitor in [Line+Spot] mode. The waveform
monitor appears on the left in green while the edge monitor appears on the right in blue. The waveform of
the area in the red frame is displayed in red on top of the edge monitor waveform.
Adding Marks while Recording MXF Clips
Adding Marks while Recording MXF Clips
When recording on a CF card, you can flag an important shot in a clip by adding a “shot mark” (!). There are
two types of shot marks, shot mark 1 (") and shot mark 2 (#), and you can add either or both types to a single
clip. You can also add an OK mark ($) or check mark (%) to the entire clip to flag clips you want to set apart.
You can add all four types of marks remotely using the Wi-Fi Remote application.
102
When the camera is in
screen of all the shot marks (A 137), allowing you to find a particular scene in a clip more quickly.
Operating modes:
Adding Shot Marks while Recording
To add a shot mark to a clip while recording, you must first set in advance an assignable button to [Add Shot
Mark 1] or [Add Shot Mark 2].
• To add both shot marks, set one assignable button to [Add Shot Mark 1] and another assignable button to
[Add Shot Mark 2].
2 While you are recording, press the assignable button at the beginning of the shot you wish to mark.
• A message indicating the short mark will appear and the selected shot mark will be added to the current
frame of the clip.
• You can press the button again to add another shot mrk. Up to 100 shot marks (" and # marks
combined) can be added to a single clip.
Remote Operation Using Wi-Fi Remote
After completing the necessary preparations (A 51) you can set a shot mark (" or #) remotely from a Wi-Fi-
enabled device using the Wi-Fi Remote application.
1 While recording a clip, press [SHOT MARK1] on the Wi-Fi Remote screen to set a shot mark 1 or
[SHOT MARK2] to set a shot mark 2.
• [Shot Mark1] or [Shot Mark2] will be displayed on the Wi-Fi Remote screen and the shot mark will be applied
to the clip.
2 Press ^ to close the message.
Adding Marks while Recording MXF Clips
NOTES
• There may be up to a 0.5 second delay from when you press the button to when the camera adds the shot
mark. When using the Wi-Fi Remote application, the delay may be longer depending on the conditions of the
wireless signal.
103
• When you are using interval recording or frame recording mode, you cannot add shot marks to a clip.
• When a clip contains either shot mark, ! will appear next to the clip’s thumbnail in the playback index screen.
Adding an $ Mark or % Mark to the Last Clip Recorded
After recording an important clip, you can add an OK mark ($) or check mark (%) to the clip to flag it and set it
apart. When the camera is in
mode, you can display an index screen that contains only clips with an $
mark or only clips with a % mark (A 128). Furthermore, you can use the $ mark to protect important clips, as
clips with an $ mark cannot be deleted.
To add an $ mark or % mark to the last clip recorded in
mode, you must first set in advance an
assignable button to [Add $ Mark] or [Add % Mark].
• To add both types of clip marks (to different clips), set one assignable button to [Add $ Mark] and another
assignable button to [Add % Mark].
2 After recording a clip, press the assignable button.
• A message indicating the clip mark will appear and the seected clip mark will be added to the clip.
Remote Operation Using Wi-Fi Remote
After completing the necessary preparations (A 51) you can set an $ mark or a % mark remotely from a
Wi-Fi-enabled device using the Wi-Fi Remote application.
1 After recording a clip, press [$ MARK] on the Wi-Fi Remote screen to set a an $ mark or
[% MARK] to set a % mark.
• [OK Mark] or [Check Mark] will be displayed on the Wi-Fi Remote screen and the mark will be applied to the
clip.
2 Press ^ to close the message.
NOTES
• A clip cannot have both an $ mark and a % mark at the same time.
Reviewing an MXF Clip
Reviewing an MXF Clip
When the camera is in
recorded on a CF card.
mode, you can review the last clip that was
[w Other Functions]
[Rec Review]
104
Operating modes:
1 Open the [Rec Review] submenu to set the review length.
[Entire Clip]
[w Other Functions] > [Rec Review]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
3 After you finish recording, press the u button.
• The last clip that was recorded is played back without audio for the
selected duration. [Ð REVIEW] appears at the top of the screen.
• Press the CANCEL button to stop reviewing the clip and change the
camera back to record pause mode.
• After the clip finishes playing back, the camera returns to record pause
mode.
Options
[Entire Clip]: Allows you to review the entire clip.
[Last 4 sec]: Allows you to review just the last 4 seconds of the clip.
NOTES
• If the camera switched CF cards during a recording, the camera will play back the clip on the CF card most
recently recorded on.
Special Recording Modes
Special Recording Modes
The camera features 4 special recording modes.
Interval recording ([Interval Rec]): A pre-defined number of frames at a pre-defined interval will be recorded
automatically. This mode is suitable for recording subjects with little movement, such as natural surroundings or
plants.
105
Frame recording ([Frame Rec]): A pre-defined number of frames will be recorded every time you press the
START/STOP button. This mode is suitable for recording stop motion animation.
Slow & fast motion recording ([Slow & Fast Motion]): This mode allows you to change the shooting frame rate to
achieve a slow motion or fast motion effect during playback.
Pre-recording ([Pre Rec]): The camera will start recording approximately 3 seconds before you press the START/
STOP button. This is especially useful when it is difficult to predict when to start recording. Pre-recording is
available only in MXF mode.
Interval Recording Mode
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[Interval Rec]
[Interval]
Set the interval and number of frames in advance. Sound is not recorded
in this mode. During 4K and 2K modes, MXF clips will not be recorded
simultaneously on a CF card even if a card is inserted in the camera.
Operating modes:
[1 sec]
Configuring Interval Recording Mode
1 Open the [Interval] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Interval Rec] > [Interval]
2 Select the desired interval and then press SET.
• See the following table for the available intervals.
3 Select [Rec Frames], select the desired number of frames and then
press SET.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[Interval Rec]
[Rec Frames]
[1]
Available Intervals
1 sec
2 sec
3 sec
4 sec
5 sec
6 sec
7 sec
1 min
8 sec
2 min
9 sec
3 min
10 sec 15 sec 20 sec 30 sec 40 sec 50 sec
4 min
5 min
6 min
7 min
8 min
9 min
10 min
Number of Frames Recorded
System priority
Frame rate
Any
Frames recorded
1, 3, 6, 9
4K
2K
59.94i, 29.97P, 23.98P, 24.00P
59.94P, 50.00i, 50.00P, 25.00P
MXF
2, 6, 12
Special Recording Modes
Activating Interval Recording Mode and Recording
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[Special Rec]
[Off]
1 Open the [Special Rec] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Special Rec]
106
2 Select [Interval Rec] and then press SET.
• [INT STBY`] (during 4K and 2K modes) or [INT STBY] (during MXF
mode) appears at the top of the screen (with [INT] flashing).
3 Press the START/STOP button to begin recording.
• The set number of frames are recorded automatically at the set interval.
• The tally lamp illuminates.
• [INT] changes to [Ü INT] while recording frames.
4 Press the START/STOP button again to stop recording.
• All of the recorded frames are joined together into one clip.
• [INT STBY`] (during 4K and 2K modes) or [INT STBY] (during MXF mode) appears at the top of the screen
(with [INT] flashing).
• The tally lamp goes out.
NOTES
• You can use only one special recording mode at a time.
• While recording, you cannot change the interval or number of frames.
• Some frames at the point the recording was stopped may be recorded and added to the end of the clip.
• Interval recording mode will be deactivated if the speciacording mode is changed or turned off. It will be
deactivated also if you change the video configura
• During this special recording mode, the running modof the time code (A 84) can be set to [Rec Run] or
[Regen.]*. The time code advances by the number of frames recorded. If the running mode of the time code
(A 84) is set to [Free Run] or the time code is input from an external source, the running mode will switch to
[Rec Run] during special recording mode. When special recording mode is deactivated, the running mode will
return to its previous setting.
• During special recording mode, the time code signal will not be output from the MON. terminals, TIME CODE
terminal or HD/SD SDI terminal. During 4K and 2K modes, the time code signal will be output from the 3G-SDI
terminals.
* During MXF mode only.
Frame Recording Mode
Set the number of frames in advance. We recommend operating the camera remotely or stabilizing the camera,
for example, on a tripod. Sound is not recorded in this mode. During 4K and 2K modes, MXF clips will not be
recorded simultaneously on a CF card even if a card is inserted in the camera.
Operating modes:
Special Recording Modes
Configuring Frame Recording Mode
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[Frame Rec]
[Rec Frames]
[1]
1 Open the [Rec Frames] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Frame Rec] > [Rec Frames]
2 Select the desired number of frames and then press SET.
107
Number of Frames Recorded
System priority
Frame rate
Any
Frames recorded
1, 3, 6, 9
4K
2K
59.94i, 29.97P, 23.98P, 24.00P
59.94P, 50.00i, 50.00P, 25.00P
MXF
2, 6, 12
Activating Frame Recording Mode and Recording
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[Special Rec]
[Off]
1 Open the [Special Rec] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Special Rec]
2 Select [Frame Rec] and then press SET.
• [FRM STBY`] (during 4K and 2K modes) or [FRM STBY] (during
MXF mode) appears at the top of the screen (with [FRM] flashing).
3 Press the START/STOP button to begin recording.
• The set number of frames are recorded automatically.
• The tally lamp illuminates.
• [FRM] changes to [Ü FRM].
• Repeat until you finish recording.
4 Open the [Special Rec] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Special Rec]
5 Select [Off] and then press SET.
• Frame recording mode ends and all of the recorded frames are joined together into one clip.
• [STBY`] (during 4K and 2K modes) or [STBY] (during MXF mode) appears at the top of the screen.
• The tally lamp goes out.
NOTES
• You can use only one special recording mode at a time.
• While recording, you cannot change the number of frames.
• Some frames at the point the recording was stopped may be recorded and added to the end of the clip.
• Frame recording mode will be deactivated if the special recording mode is changed or turned off. It will be
deactivated also if you change the video configuration.
• During this special recording mode, the running mode of the time code (A 84) can be set to [Rec Run] or
[Regen.]*. The time code advances by the number of frames recorded. If the running mode of the time code
(A 84) is set to [Free Run] or the time code is input from an external source, the running mode will switch to
[Rec Run] during special recording mode. When special recording mode is deactivated, the running mode will
return to its previous setting.
• During special recording mode, the time code signal will not be output from the MON. terminals, TIME CODE terminal
or HD/SD SDI terminal. During 4K and 2K modes, the time code signal will be output from the 3G-SDI terminals.
* During MXF mode only.
Special Recording Modes
Slow & Fast Motion Mode
When you set the the frame rate to a progressive frame rate (A 62), the camera can record with a frame rate
(shooting frame rate) that is different from the playback frame rate. Recording a clip at a higher frame rate than
the [Frame Rate] setting will result in a slow motion effect during playback (up to 1/2.5 of the original speed).
Conversely, a lower frame rate will result in a fast motion effect (up to 60x the original speed). Sound is not
recorded in this mode. During 4K and 2K modes, MXF clips will not be recorded simultaneously on a CF card
even if a card is inserted in the camera.
108
Operating modes:
Configuring Slow & Fast Motion Mode
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[S&F Frame Rate]
[24]
1 Open the [S&F Frame Rate] submenu.
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [S&F Frame Rate]
[
2 Select the desired shooting frame rate and then press SET.
• Available shooting frame rates depend on other video configuration
settings in use.
Available Shooting Frame Rates
Video configuration
Shooting frame rate
(fps, in 1 fps unless otherwise noted)
System priority
System
Recording mode/
Vertical resolution
frequency
RAW
1 to 30
1it
0-bit
2
32 to 60 (in 2 fps increments)
59.94 Hz
24.00 Hz
1
HRAW
1 to 60
2
62 to 120 (in 2 fps increments)
4K
2K
RAW
1 to 25
12-bit
10-bit
2
26 to 50 (in 2 fps increments)
50.00 Hz
HRAW
1 to 50
2
52 to 100 (in 2 fps increments)
1080
720
1 to 30
1 to 60
1 to 25
1 to 50
59.94 Hz
24.00 Hz
MXF
1080
720
50.00 Hz
1
2
The recording mode cannot be set to [HRAW] or [YCC422] for this system frequency.
This range is in 2 fps increments. When the shooting frame rate appears in brackets on the screen, this indicates that both
3G-SDI terminals are required for output.
Activating Slow & Fast Motion Mode and Recording
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[Special Rec]
[Off]
1 Open the [Special Rec] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Special Rec]
2 Select [Slow & Fast Motion] and then press SET.
• [S&F STBY`] (during 4K and 2K modes) or [S&F STBY] (during MXF
mode) appears at the top of the screen.
• The selected shooting frame rate appears on the right of the screen
next to the frame rate setting (the playback frame rate).
Special Recording Modes
Shooting frame rate
109
Playback frame rate
3 Press the START/STOP button to begin recording.
• The tally lamp illuminates.
• [S&F] changes to [Ü S&F] while recording.
4 Press the START/STOP button again to stop recording.
• A clip is recorded at the set frame rate.
• [S&F STBY`] (during 4K and 2K modes) or [S&F STBY] (during MXF mode) appears at the top of the
screen.
• The tally lamp goes out.
Setting the Shooting Frame Rate from the Shooting Screen
If you set an assignable button to [S&F Frame Rate], you can conveniently set the shooting frame rate from the
shooting screen without having to go through the menus.
2 Press the assignable button.
• The shooting frame rate will be highlighted in orage.
3 Push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT diaselect the desired frame rate.
4 Press SET.
• The display of the shooting frame rate will return to normal.
NOTES
• You can use only one special recording mode at a time. In addition, slow & fast motion mode cannot be used
with double slot recording.
• While recording, you cannot change the shooting frame rate.
• For lower shooting frame rates, it may take approximately 1 second to stop recording.
• During special recording mode, the time code signal will not be output from the MON. terminals, TIME CODE
terminal or HD/SD SDI terminal. During 4K and 2K modes, the time code signal will be output from the 3G-SDI
terminals.
• Slow & fast motion mode will be deactivated if the special recording mode is changed or turned off. It will be
deactivated also if you change the video configuration.
• When the bit rate in the [ 4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [MXF] > [Bit Rate/Resolution] setting is set to [50 Mbps
1920x1080] or [50 Mbps 1280x720], relay recording is not available during slow motion recording.
• During 4K and 2K modes, the running mode of the time code (A 84) is set to [Free Run] and cannot be
changed. During MXF mode, the running mode is set to [Regen.]. The time code advances while video is
recorded. If the running mode of the time code is set to [Free Run] or the time code is input from an external
source, the running mode will switch to [Rec Run] during special recording mode. When special recording
mode is deactivated, the running mode will return to its previous setting.
Special Recording Modes
Pre-recording Mode
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[Special Rec]
[Off]
When pre-recording mode is activated, the camera starts recording
continuously into a temporary memory of approximately 3 seconds so
when you press the START/STOP button, the clip will contain also
approximately 3 seconds of video and audio recorded before you pressed
the button.
110
Operating modes:
2 Open the [Special Rec] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Special Rec]
3 Select [Pre Rec] and then press SET.
• [PRE REC STBY] appears at the top of the screen.
4 Press the START/STOP button to begin recording.
• The tally lamp illuminates.
• [PRE REC STBY] changes to [Ü PRE REC] while recording.
5 Press the START/STOP button again to stop recording.
• The camera records the clip, including approximately 3 seconds of video and audio recorded before the
START/STOP button was pressed.
• The tally lamp goes out and [PRE REC STBY] appears at the top of the screen.
NOTES
• You can use only one special recording mode at a time.
• Pre-recording mode will be deactivated if the special recording mode is changed or turned off. It will be
deactivated also if you change the video configuration.
• During pre-recording mode, the time code will be recorded with the running mode (A 84) set to [Free Run],
regardless of the previous setting. Alternatively, you can use an external time code signal. When the time code
is recorded, it will include the 3 seconds before the START/STOP button was pressed. When special recording
mode is deactivated, the running mode will return to its previous setting.
Customization
4
111
Assignable Buttons
The camera allows you to assign various functions to 15 buttons*. By assigning often-used functions, you can
quickly access them with a single press of a button. Some assignable buttons are located on the monitor unit so
their availability depends on the camera configuration used.
* In
mode, only assignable buttons 1 to 9 are available.
Operating modes:
Changing the Assigned Function
[w Other Functions]
1 Open the [Assign Button] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Assign Button]
[Assign Button]
2 Select the button to change and then press SET.
• A list of available functions appears.
[1 MAGN.]
[2 PEAKING]
[3 ZEBRA]
[4 WFM]
[5 LENS EXCHANGE]
[6 LUT]
[7 MAGN.]
[8 WFM]
[9 EDGE MON.]
[10-15 (NONE)]
• The quick reference to the right shows the default settings for each
assignable button. Also, the label on the camera for assignable
buttons 1 to 9 indicates the default setting*. By default, buttons 10 to
15 have no assignable function set.
* Assignable button 7 is usable only when you attach the grip unit of the C300 or
C300 PL.
3 Select the desired function and then press SET.
• If you selected [User Setting (NONE)], the menu will change from
orange to blue to indicate you are selecting a menu setting to register.
Continue the procedure to register a menu setting. Otherwise, you do
not need to perform the rest of the procedure.
4 Navigate the menus to find the menu setting you want to register and then press SET.
• The selected menu setting will be registered to the customizable slot and to the assignable button.
• The name of the selected menu setting will be listed instead of [User Setting (NONE)] and the customizable
slot will be marked by a ¥.
Assignable Buttons
NOTES
• You can check the two [Assign Button] status screens (A 179) to see what functions are set for the
assignable buttons.
• You can reset only the functions assigned to the assignable buttons, without affecting other camera settings,
with the [w Other Functions] >[Reset] > [Assignable Buttons] function. All the assignable buttons will return
to their default function.
112
Using an Assignable Button
After you assign a function to one of the buttons, press the button to activate the function. For some functions,
an options menu may appear. In such case, select the desired option and then press SET.
Assignable Functions
Functions can be set separately in
mode and
mode. Refer to the following table for assignable
functions and available modes.
Function name
Description
A
[PEAKING]
[ZEBRA]
Turns peaking on/off.
Ü
Ü
–
–
Turns zebra patterns on/off.
Activates video scopes in the following sequence:
Waveform monitor J Vectorscope J Off
[WFM]
Ü
Ü
[EDGE MON.]
[MAGN.]
Turns the edge monitor on/off.
Turns magnification on/off.
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
–
[Color Bars]
[Markers]
Turns color bars on/off.
–
Turns onscreen markers on/off.
Opens the [LCD Setup] submenu.
Opens the [VF Setup] submenu.
Turns the B&W mode of the LCD and viewfinder on/off.
Turns view assistance on/off.
Turns the LUT on/off.
–
[LCD Setup]
[VF Setup]
[LCD/VF B&W]
[View Assist.]
[LUT]*
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
–
[Resize MON.
Output]
Switches the resizing method of the MON. 1 terminal output in the following sequence:
Letterbox J Squeeze J Side Crop
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
–
[Resize MXF
Output]
Switches the resizing method of MXF clips in the following sequence:
Letterbox J Squeeze J Side Crop
Turns on/off the inclusion of onscreen displays on video output from the HD/SD SDI
terminal, HDMI OUT terminal and SYNC OUT terminal (both HD and SD video output).
[Onscreen Display]
Ü
[Add Shot Mark 1] Adds an " mark to the clip.
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
[Add Shot Mark 2]* Adds an # mark to the clip.
[Add $ Mark]
[Add % Mark]
[Time Code]
Adds an $ mark to the clip.
Adds a % mark to the clip.
Displays the [Time Code] submenu.
[Time Code Hold]* Puts the time code display on hold or resumes it.
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
[Headphone +]
[Headphone -]
Increases the headphone volume.
Reduces the headphone volume.
[Audio Output CH] Switches the audio channel for audio output from the × terminal.
[Audio Level]
[Photo]*
Turns the audio level meter on/off.
Records a photo.
[FUNC.]
Enters the direct setting mode, replicating the function of the camera’s FUNC. button.
Assignable Buttons
Function name
[FUNC. Shutter]
Description
A
Enters the direct setting mode with the shutter speed highlighted and ready to be
adjusted.
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
–
–
Enters the direct setting mode with the ISO speed or gain value highlighted and ready
to be adjusted.
[FUNC. ISO/Gain]
[FUNC. WB]
113
Enters the direct setting mode with the white balance highlighted and ready to be
adjusted.
[S&F Frame Rate]* Allows you to set the shooting frame rate during slow & fast recording mode.
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
–
[My Menu]
Opens the [My Menu] customized submenu.
Opens the [Initialize Media] submenu.
[Initialize Media]
Ü
–
[LENS EXCHANGE]* Turns the lens exchange mode on/off.
[User Setting
Customizable slot. Assign to the button any menu setting you would like to register.
Ü
Ü
–
(NONE)]*
* Function can be used only by assigning it to a button.
Custom Picture Settings
Custom Picture Settings
You can preset a number of picture-related settings (A 117) for clips recorded on a CF card or video output
from the various terminals (except the 3G-SDI terminals and MON. terminals). After changing individual settings
to your preference, you can save the whole set in the camera or SD card as a custom picture file. You can then
load the file at a later date to change the current settings to the preset levels you selected. You can even add
custom picture settings to MXF clips recorded on a CF card or photos recorded on an SD card.
You can save up to 9 different custom picture files on the camera and up to 20 custom picture files on an SD
card. Custom picture files can be copied between the camera and recording media.
114
Custom picture files created with this camera are compatible only with other C500 and C500 PL cameras or
C300 and C300 PL camcorders.
Operating modes:
Selecting Custom Picture Files
Select a custom picture file to apply its settings to your
recordings or to edit, rename, protect, or transfer it.
2 Press the CUSTOM PICTURE button.
• The custom picture menu appears. The currently selected
file appears next to the - icon or [Off] if no file is seleed.
3 Select [- / Select File] and then press SET.
• You can select from a list of custom picture files in the
camera and SD card. Files in the camera begin with [C1] to
[C9]; those on the SD card begin with [SD1] to [SD20].
4 Select the desired file and then press SET.
• Select [Off] to record without applying any custom picture settings.
• To apply the file’s settings, press the CUSTOM PICTURE button to exit the custom picture menu. An icon
representing the selected custom picture file will appear on the left of the screen.
• To perform other operations on the file, continue with the following procedures.
Preset Custom Picture Files
By default, the custom picture files in the camera in file slots [C8] and [C9] are protected. Remove the
[C8: CINEMA]: Uses the Canon Log gamma and color matrix for an outstanding dynamic range and an
image suitable for processing in post-production.
[C9: EOS Std.]: Reproduces the image quality and look (high contrast, vibrant colors) of an EOS digital SLR
camera with its picture style set to [Standard].
Editing a Custom Picture File’s Settings
1 After selecting a file, select [, / Edit File] and then press SET.
2 Select a setting and then press SET.
Custom Picture Settings
3 Change the setting to the desired level and then press SET.
• Repeat steps 2 and 3 for other settings, as necessary.
4 Press the CUSTOM PICTURE button to exit the custom picture menu and apply the new custom
picture settings.
115
Resetting the current file’s settings to default values
1 Select [Reset] and then press SET.
2 Select the default values and then press SET.
• Select [NEUTRAL] to reset to neutral default values (equivalent to not using custom picture settings at all) or
[CINEMA] or [EOS Std.] if you want to replicate these preset settings, for example as a starting point to edit
them further.
3 Select [OK] and then press SET.
Renaming Custom Picture Files
[, / Edit File]
1 After selecting a file, open the [Rename] submenu.
[, / Edit File] > [Rename]
• A screen appears that displays the current file name with an orange
selection frame on the first character.
[Rename]
2 Select an alphanumeric character or symbol then ove (Ð) to the next field.
• Change the rest of the name in the same way.
3 Select [Set] and then press SET.
4 Press the CUSTOM PICTURE button to exit the custom picture menu and apply the selected custom
picture settings.
Protecting Custom Picture Files
[, / Edit File]
Protecting a custom picture file prevents its settings from being
accidentally changed.
[Protect]
1 After selecting a file, open the [Protect] submenu.
[, / Edit File] > [Protect]
2 Select [Protect] and then press SET.
• In the custom picture menu, i will appear next to the file name.
• To remove protection settings, select [Unprotect] instead.
3 Press the CUSTOM PICTURE button to exit the custom picture menu and apply the selected custom
picture settings.
Transferring Custom Picture Files
You can transfer custom picture files between the camera and SD card. When the custom picture file is in the
camera, use [Copy To *] or [Load From *] depending on the operation you wish to perform. Similarly, when
the custom picture file is on an SD card, use [Copy To Cam.] or [Load From Cam].
Custom Picture Settings
Copying a File from the Camera to an SD Card
[+ / Transfer File]
1 After selecting a file in the camera, open the [Copy To *] submenu.
[+ / Transfer File] > [Copy To *]
[Copy To *]
116
2 Select the file slot on the SD card under which to save the file and then
press SET.
• If there are available slots, you can select [New File] to save the file in the first available slot.
3 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The currently selected file will be copied to the selected slot on the SD card, overwriting the file in that slot.
When the confirmation screen appears, press SET.
4 Press the CUSTOM PICTURE button to exit the custom picture menu and apply the selected custom picture
settings.
Replacing a File in the Camera with a File on an SD Card
[+ / Transfer File]
1 After selecting a file in the camera to replace, open the [Load From *]
submenu.
[Load From *]
[+ / Transfer File] > [Load From *]
2 Select the file to transfer to the camera and then press SET.
3 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The file in the camera will be overwritten by the one on the SD card. When the confirmation screen appears,
press SET.
4 Press the CUSTOM PICTURE button to exit the custom cture menu and apply the selected custom picture
settings.
Copying a File from an SD Card to the Camera
[+ / Transfer File]
1 After selecting a file on the SD card, open the [Copy To Cam.]
submenu.
[Copy To Cam.]
[+ / Transfer File] > [Copy To Cam.]
2 Select the file slot under which to save the file and then press SET.
3 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The currently selected file will be copied to the selected slot on the camera, overwriting the file in that slot.
When the confirmation screen appears, press SET.
4 Press the CUSTOM PICTURE button to exit the custom picture menu and apply the selected custom picture
settings.
Replacing a File on an SD Card with a File in the Camera
[+ / Transfer File]
1 After selecting a file on the SD card to replace, open the [Load From
Cam.] submenu.
[Load From Cam.]
[+ / Transfer File] > [Load From Cam.]
2 Select the file to transfer to the SD card and then press SET.
3 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The file on the SD card will be overwritten by the one on the camera. When the confirmation screen
appears, press SET.
4 Press the CUSTOM PICTURE button to exit the custom picture menu and apply the selected custom picture
settings.
Custom Picture Settings
NOTES
117
Embedding Custom Picture Settings in a Recording
[w Other Functions]
By default, when you record an MXF clip or take a photo with custom
picture settings applied to it, the custom picture file used to record it is
embedded in the image file. Later, those embedded settings in the MXF
future recordings. You may find that embedding custom picture settings in
a recording helps you keep track of them, such as verifying what settings
were used for a particular recording.
[Add / File]
[To Clip] … [On]
[To Photo] … [On]
1 Open the [Add / File] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Add / File]
2 Select [To Clip] or [To Photo] and then press SET.
• Selecting [To Clip] will embed the custom picture file in a clip, while selecting [To Photo] will embed the file in
a photo.
3 Select [On] or [Off] and then press SET.
Available Custom Picture Settings
The following are the available settings. Even if no custom picture file is selected, the default settings are still
applied to the picture.
[Gamma]
The gamma curve changes the overall look of the image. (Default: [Normal 1]).
[Normal 1] to [Normal 4]: These settings are suitable for viewing the image on a TV monitor. Highlights in
[Normal 2] are brighter than those of [Normal 1]. Dark tones in the lower part of the
gamma curve for [Normal 3] (ITU-R BT.709 standard) and [Normal 4] are more
pronounced than those of [Normal 2].
[Cine 1] or [Cine 2]:
Use [Cine 1] for a gamma curve that results in a picture with a cinema-like feel and
cinema-like tones. [Cine 2] has softer contrasts than does [Cine 1] but is also suitable
for creating a cinema-like picture.
[Canon Log]:
[EOS Std.]:
Applies a logarithmic gamma curve for outstanding dynamic range. Requires image
processing in post-production.
This gamma curve approximates the look of an EOS digital SLR camera when the
picture style is set to [Standard] (high contrast, vibrant colors).
Custom Picture Settings
Gamma
Canon log
Cine 1
Cine 2
Normal 2/3/4
118
Normal 1
Canon Log
Normal 4
Normal 3
Normal 1/2
Input
Input
[Black]
Controls the black level and color cast of blacks.
[Master Pedestal]
The master pedestal increases or decreases the black level. Higher settings will make dark areas brighter but
decrease contrast. This setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50. (Default: 0)
[Master Black]
Corrects color cast in blacks.
[Red]: -50 to 50 (Default: 0)
[Green]: -50 to 50 (Default: 0)
[Blue]: -50 to 50 (Default: 0)
[Black Gamma]
Controls the lower part of the gamma curve (dark areas of the image). This setting is not available when [Gamma]
is set to [Canon Log].
[Level]: Raises or lowers the lower part of the gamma curve. This setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50.
(Default: 0)
[Range]: Selects the range in which dark areas are affected. This setting can be adjusted from -5 to 50.
(Default: 0)
[Point]: Determines the shape of the lower part of the gamma curve. This setting can be adjusted from -1 to 50.
(Default: 0)
Black Gamma
Point
Input
[Low Key Satur.]
Adjusts color saturation in dark areas.
Custom Picture Settings
[Enable]: Activates/deactivates the setting. (Default: [Off])
[Level]: Specifies how saturated colors are in dark areas. This setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50.
(Default: 0)
[Knee]
119
Controls the upper part of the gamma curve (highlights of the image). By compressing the highlights, you can
prevent parts of the image from being overexposed. This is not available when [Gamma] is set to [Cine 1],
[Cine 2], [Canon Log] or [EOS Std.].
[Enable]:
[Slope]:
Activates/deactivates the setting. (Default: [On])
Determines the slope of the gamma curve above the knee point. This setting can be adjusted from
-35 to 50. (Default: 0)
[Point]:
Sets the knee point of the gamma curve. This setting can be adjusted from 50 to 109. (Default: 95)
[Saturation]: Adjusts color saturation in highlights. This setting can be adjusted from -10 to 10. (Default: 0)
Knee Slope Knee Point
Input
Input
[Sharpness]
Sets the sharpness of the output and recording signal.
[Level]: Sets the sharpness level. This setting can be adjusted from -10 to 50. (Default: 0)
[H Detail Freq.]: Sets the center frequency of horizontal sharpness. Setting higher values increases the
frequency, which, in turn, increases the sharpness. This setting can be adjusted from -8 to 8.
(Default: 0)
[Coring]:
Reduces noise artifacts caused by high sharpness levels.
[Level]: Sets the coring level. Higher values prevent sharpness from being applied to minute details, resulting in
less noise. This setting can be adjusted from -30 to 50. (Default: 0)
[D-Ofst]: You can use [D-Ofst], [D-Curve] and [D-Depth] to adjust the coring level based on brightness. [D-Ofst]
sets the coring level of the minimum brightness level. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 50. (Default: 0)
[D-Curve]: Sets the curve of the coring adjustment. This curve is the change from [Level] to [D-Ofst]. This setting
can be adjusted from 0 to 8. (Default: 0)
[D-Depth]: Sets a multiplier to [D-Ofst] that determines the coring level adjustment based on brightness.
Positive values raise the coring level in dark areas and negative values lower the level. This setting can be
adjusted from -4 to 4. (Default: 0)
[HV Detail Bal.]: Adjusts the ratio between horizontal and vertical detail. Higher values emphasize vertical detail
while lower values emphasize horizontal detail. This setting can be adjusted from -8 to 8.
(Default: 0)
[Limit]:
Restricts how much sharpness is applied. This setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50.
(Default: 0)
Custom Picture Settings
[Select]:
In addition to the sharpness set by [Level], [Select] sets the sharpness for areas with higher
frequencies. Higher values apply more sharpness to areas with higher frequencies. Use this for
subjects in which normal sharpening is not effective. This setting is not available when the video
configuration is 720P. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 15. (Default: 0)
120
[
Knee Aperture]: Allows you to set the sharpness of only the areas above the knee point by adjusting the gain and
slope. This is not available when [Gamma] is set to [Cine 1], [Cine 2], [Canon Log] or [EOS Std.].
[Gain]: Sets the amount of sharpness. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 9. (Default: 0)
[Slope]: Sets the slope of the sharpness. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 3, with 0 having no slope,
1 having a steep slope and 3 having a gradual slope. (Default: 1)
[Level Depend]: Lowers the amount of sharpness applied to dark areas of the image.
[Level]: Sets the brightness of the dark areas of the image that will be affected. This setting can be adjusted
from 0 to 50. (Default: 0)
[Slope]: Determines the slope of the area between the upper and lower parts of the gamma curve. This setting
can be adjusted from 0 to 3, with 0 having no slope, 1 having a steep slope and 3 having a gradual slope.
(Default: 0)
[Offset]: Adjusts the sharpness level of dark areas in the image. Setting higher values will lower the sharpness
level. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 50. (Default: 0)
[Noise Reduction]
Reduces the amount of noise that appears in the image. Select a level from 1 (lowest level) to 12 (highest level),
or select [Off] to turn the noise reduction off. (Default: [Off])
[Skin Detail]
The camera applies a softening filter to areas in the picturith skin tones to give a more pleasant appearance.
By changing these settings, you can determine what s will be detected as skin tones. A zebra pattern will
appear over areas on the screen that are detectd as ving skin tones.
[Effect Level]: Adjusts the level of the filter. The available options are [Off], [Low], [Middle] and [High].
(Default: [Off])
[Hue]:
Adjusts the hue for detection of skin tones. This setting can be adjusted from -16 to 16.
(Default: 0)
[Chroma]:
[Area]:
Adjusts the color saturation for detection of skin tones. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31.
(Default: 16)
Adjusts the color range for detection of skin tones. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31.
(Default: 16)
[Y Level]:
Adjusts the brightness for detection of skin tones. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31.
(Default: 16)
[Selective NR]
The camera detects the characteristics of a certain color or tone and applies a noise reduction filter to the
targeted areas. A zebra pattern will appear over targeted areas on the screen.
[Effect Level]:Adjusts the level of the noise reduction filter. The available options are [Off], [Low], [Middle] and
[High]. (Default: [Off])
[Hue]:
Adjusts the hue for the color to be detected. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31. (Default: 0)
[Chroma]:
Adjusts the color saturation for the color to be detected. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31.
(Default: 16)
[Area]:
Adjusts the color range for the color to be detected. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31.
(Default: 16)
[Y Level]:
Adjusts the brightness for the color to be detected. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31.
(Default: 16)
[Color Matrix]
Color matrix affects the color tones throughout the whole image.
Custom Picture Settings
[Select]: Available options are [Normal 1] to [Normal 4], [Cine 1] and [Cine 2], [Canon Log] and [EOS Std.].
Generally, this is the same setting as [Gamma]. After selecting an option, you can make more precise
adjustments. (Default: [Normal 1])
[Gain]: Adjusts the color intensity. This setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50. (Default: 0)
[Phase]: Adjusts the color phase. This setting can be adjusted from -18 to 18. (Default: 0)
121
[R-G]: The R-G matrix changes the tint of the picture along the cyan/green and red/magenta gradations. This
setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50. (Default: 0)
[R-B]: The R-B matrix changes the tint of the picture along the cyan/blue and red/yellow gradations. This
setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50. (Default: 0)
[G-R]: The G-R matrix changes the tint of the picture along the magenta/red and green/cyan gradations. This
setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50. (Default: 0)
[G-B]: The G-B matrix changes the tint of the picture along the magenta/blue and green/yellow gradations.
This setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50. (Default: 0)
[B-R]: The B-R matrix changes the tint of the picture along the yellow/red and blue/cyan gradations. This
setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50. (Default: 0)
[B-G]: The B-G matrix changes the tint of the picture along the yellow/green and blue/magenta gradations.
This setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50. (Default: 0)
[White Balance]
Adjusts the amount of white balance throughout the whole image.
[R Gain]: Adjust the intensity of red tones. This setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50. (Default: 0)
[G Gain]: Adjust the intensity of green tones. This setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50. (Default: 0)
[B Gain]: Adjust the intensity of blue tones. This setting cbe adjusted from -50 to 50. (Default: 0)
[Color Correction]
The camera detects the characteristics of a certain color (color phase, chroma, area and Y level) and corrects
them when recording. You can set the color correction for up to two different areas (A and B).
[Select Area]: Selects the area or areas to correct. Available options are [Area A], [Area B] and [Area A&B].
Select [Off] to turn this setting off. (Default: [Off])
[Area A Setting]: Determines the area in which colors will be corrected.
[Phase]: Adjusts the color phase for area A. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31. (Default: 0)
[Chroma]: Adjusts the color saturation for area A. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31. (Default: 16)
[Area]: Adjusts the color range for area A. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31. (Default: 16)
[Y Level]: Adjusts the brightness for area A. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31. (Default: 16)
[Area A Revision]: Sets the amount of correction for area A.
[Level]: Adjusts the amount of correction to the color saturation. This setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50.
(Default: 0)
[Phase]: Adjusts the amount of correction to the color phase. This setting can be adjusted from -18 to 18.
(Default: 0)
[Area B Setting]: Determines the area in which colors will be corrected.
[Phase]: Adjusts the color phase for area B. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31. (Default: 0)
[Chroma]: Adjusts the color saturation for area B. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31. (Default: 16)
[Area]: Adjusts the color range for area B. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31. (Default: 16)
[Y Level]: Adjusts the brightness for area B. This setting can be adjusted from 0 to 31. (Default: 16)
[Area B Revision]: Sets the amount of correction for area B.
[Level]: Adjusts the amount of correction to the color saturation. This setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50.
(Default: 0)
[Phase]: Adjusts the amount of correction to the color phase. This setting can be adjusted from -18 to 18.
(Default: 0)
Custom Picture Settings
[Other Functions]
[Setup Level]: Adjusts the black level set by the [Black] and [Master Pedestal] settings.
[Level]: Determines the amount of adjustment to be made. This setting can be adjusted from -50 to 50.
(Default: 0)
122
[Press]: Compresses the dynamic range of the video signal so that it does not exceed 100%. Available options
are [On] and [Off]. (Default: [Off])
[Clip At 100%]: When the video signal exceeds 100%, this function clips the white level at 100%. Available
options are [On] and [Off]. (Default: [Off])
Customizing Functions and Onscreen Displays
Customizing Functions and Onscreen Displays
Customize the camera to match your shooting style and needs. Use the [w Other Functions] > [Custom
Function] setting to adjust how some of the camera’s controls and functions operate in
use the [£ LCD/VF Setup] > [Custom Display 1] or [Custom Display 2] setting to customize the onscreen
displays that appear during recording on the screen. You can save these preferences along with other menu
mode. Similarly,
123
Customizing Functions
[w Other Functions]
The following table describes which functions can be customized using
[Custom Function].
[Custom Function]
Operating modes:
1 Open the [Custom Function] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Custom Function]
2 Select the desired function.
3 Change the setting option and then press SET.
Customizable Functions with [Custom Function]
Menu item
Setting options
[On], [Off]
Description
[Shockless WB]
Creates softtransition when the white balance is changed.
2 [Iris], [ISO/Gain], [Off]
3 [ISO/Gain], [Off]
[Control Dial]
Select the nction of the control dial.
[Control Dial Dir.]
[Reverse], [Normal]
Changes the direction of the adjustment when operating the control dial.
Changes the direction of the adjustment when operating the control dial on the grip
unit of a C300 / C300 PL camcorder, which can be attached to the GRIP terminal.
[Grip Ctrl Dial Dir.] [Reverse], [Normal]
[SELECT Dial Dir.] [Reverse], [Normal]
Changes the direction of the adjustment when operating the SELECT dial.
Automatically switches the screen to B&W while the focus assist functions (peaking and
[F. Assist. B&W]
[Both], [Magnify], [Peaking], [Off] magnification) are activated. You can have the screen switch to B&W when only the
peaking is activated, when only the magnification is activated or when both are activated.
[Magn. Add. Disp.] [Peaking], [Edge Mon.], [Off]
[3D Rec Mode] [On], [Off]
Displays peaking or the edge monitor when magnification is enabled.
When using another C500 or C500 PL camera to shoot 3D, this function
compensates for the video and audio signals output from the 3G-SDI terminals and
MON. terminals not being synchronized.
Inverts the recorded image horizontally and/or vertically. This also inverts the image
[Scan Reverse Rec] [Both], [Vertical], [Horizontal], [Off] output from the 3G-SDI terminals, MON. terminals, HD/SD SDI terminal and HDMI
OUT terminal.
When this function is set to [On], all of the onscreen displays will be recorded on the CF
card exactly as they appear on the screen.
[Character Rec]
[On], [Off]
Customizing Onscreen Displays
[£ LCD/VF Setup]
For details on which onscreen displays can be customized, refer to
[Custom Display 1]
[Custom Display 2]
Operating modes:
Customizing Functions and Onscreen Displays
1 Open the [Custom Display 1] or [Custom Display 2] submenu.
[£ LCD/VF Setup] > [Custom Display 1] or [Custom Display 2]
2 Select the desired onscreen display.
3 Change the setting option and then press SET.
124
Saving and Loading Camera Settings
Saving and Loading Camera Settings
After you adjust custom picture settings and settings in the various menus, you can save those settings on an
SD card. You can load those settings at a later date or on another C500 or C500 PL camera so that you can use
that camera in that same exact way.
125
Operating modes:
Saving Camera Settings to an SD Card
[w Other Functions]
1 Open the [Save To *] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Transfer Menu//] > [Save To *]
[Transfer Menu//]
2 Select [Menu] or [Menu+/] and then press SET.
• Selecting [Menu] will save menu settings and [Menu+/] will save
[Save To *]
menu and custom picture settings.
3 Select [OK] and press SET.
• The current settings are saved to the SD card. If the SD card already has camera settings on it, they will be
overwritten.
4 When the confirmation screen appears, press SET.
Loading Camera Settings from an SD Ca
[w Other Functions]
1 Open the [Load From *] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Transfer Menu//] > [Load From *]
[Transfer Menu//]
2 Select [Menu] or [Menu+/] and then press SET.
• Selecting [Menu] will load menu settings and [Menu+/] will load
[Load From *]
menu and custom picture settings.
3 Select [OK] and press SET.
• After the camera’s current settings are replaced with the settings saved on the SD card, the screen will turn
black momentarily and the camera will restart.
NOTES
• The SD card includes a text file that lists the camera settings. You can check the settings by using a USB card
reader to access the SD card on a computer. In the “PRIVATE\CAMSET” folder, open the file “CAMSET5.TXT”.
• When loading camera settings from an SD card, even protected custom picture files in the camera will be
replaced.
• For your protection, when the camera’s settings are saved on an SD card, the following settings under
[w Other Functions] > [Wi-Fi Remote] are not saved: the encryption key/WEP index key in the wireless LAN
setup of each of the configuration files [No. 1] to [No. 5] and the password in the camera settings.
• Only camera settings from other C500 / C500 PL cameras can be used with this camera.
Saving and Loading Camera Settings
126
Playback
5
127
Playing Back MXF Clips
This section explains how to play back clips recorded on a CF card. For details on playing back clips using an
external monitor, refer to Connecting to an External Monitor (A 144). For details on viewing photos on the SD
card, refer to Viewing Photos (A 161). You cannot use this camera to play back video recorded in 4K or 2K
mode on an external recorder. For details on developing RAW clips in order to play them back, refer to
Operating modes:
Clip Index Screen
Playback functions are accessed from the clip index screen. To open the
clip index screen, set the camera to
mode.
Set the Q switch to MEDIA.
• The camera switches to
mode and the clip index screen appears.
7
8
9
10
11
1
2
3
4
5
6
12
13
14
15
16
17
Playing Back MXF Clips
1
2
3
Orange selection frame
Relay recording: Appears when a clip begins on
Recording date and time
9
10 Clip number / Total number of clips
11 Recording date (month and day only) and time
13 Time code of thumbnail
128
4
5
6
7
8
14 Total recording time
17 Frame rate*
* When playing back clips that were recorded using slow & fast motion mode, the shooting frame rate and playback frame rate will
both be displayed.
v
Switching Between the CF Card Slots
If both CF card slots contain a CF card, you can switch between them as
necessary.
Operating modes:
Press the SLOT SELECT button.
• The access indicator of the selected CF card slot will illuminate in green.
Switching to Other Index Screens
All of the clips on a CF card can be accessed from thip ndex screen.
However, you can switch to other index screens that sw only clips with
an $ mark ([$ Mark] index screen), clips with a % mark ([% Mark]
index screen), or photos* ([Photos] index screen).
* Photos are saved on the SD card.
1 Press the INDEX button.
• The index screen selection menu appears.
2 Select the desired index screen and then press SET.
• The selected index screen appears.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
• Press the INDEX button again to return to the clip index screen.
Playing Back Clips
You can play back clips from the clip index screen, [$ Mark] index
screen and [% Mark] index screen. Use the playback control buttons
on the monitor unit. When the monitor unit is not attached, you have
limited playback control options (play/pause/stop only) with the
buttons on the camera and full playback control options using the
joystick and joystick guide.
1 Move the orange selection frame to the clip you want to play
back.
2 Press the Ò button to start playback.
Playing Back MXF Clips
• Playback will start from the clip selected and continue until the end of the last clip in the index screen. When
the last frame of the last clip is reached, playback will be paused.
• Press the Ò button again or press SET to pause/resume the playback.
• Press the Ñ button to stop the playback and return to the index screen.
129
IMPORTANT
• Observe the following precautions while the CF2 or CF3 access indicator is illuminated in red. Failure to do
so may result in permanent data loss.
- Do not disconnect the power source or turn off the camera.
- Do not open the cover of the CF card slot being accessed.
NOTES
• You may notice brief stops in video or audio playback between clips.
Onscreen Displays
7
8 9 10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
1
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Recording date and time2
Playback operation
12 Clip number / Total number of clips
20 Audio level meter
Selected CF card
Relay recording
1
2
3
Appears when [£ LCD/VF Setup] > [Metadata Display] > [Camera Data] is set to [On].
Appears when [£ LCD/VF Setup] > [Metadata Display] > [Date/Time] is set to [On].
When playing back clips that were recorded using slow & fast motion mode, the shooting frame rate and playback frame rate will
both be displayed.
Playing Back MXF Clips
7 Playback operation
Ð PLAY
Playback
Ý PAUSE
Ô/Ó
F FWD ×
Ø F REV
Playback pause
130
Frame reverse/Frame advance
Fast playback*
Fast reverse playback*
* The playback speed (x5, x15 or x60) will also appear in the indicator.
9 Relay recording
Appears when a clip begins on one CF card and continues uninterrupted on the other. 5 indicates the first
part of the recording, 6 indicates the middle part(s) and 7 indicates the last part.
Playback Controls
When you play back a clip, operate the buttons on camera’s body or
on the monitor unit or use the joystick and joystick guide to use fast
playback, play back frame-by-frame or skip clips. Refer to the
following table.
Available Playback Types
Playback type
Operation
Buttons: Press the Ø or × butt
Joystick: During playback, push he joysup or down.
Repeat to increase the playback speed to approximately
5x J 15x J 60x the normal speed.
Fast playback
Joystick: During playback pause, push the joystick up or
down.
Frame advance/reverse
Skip to the beginning of
the next clip
Buttons: Press the Ù button.
Joystick: Push the joystick right.
Skip to the beginning of
the current clip
Buttons: Press the Ú button.
Joystick: Push the joystick left.
Buttons: Press the Ú button twice.
Joystick: Push the joystick left twice.
Skip to the previous clip
Return to playback mode
Buttons: Press the Ò button.
Joystick: Press the joystick itself (SET button).
NOTES
• There is no audio during any of the playback types listed in the previous table.
• During some special playback modes, you may notice some anomalies (blocky video artifacts, banding, etc.)
in the playback picture.
• The speed indicated on the screen is approximate.
• During frame advance, the time advanced between frames depends on the video configuration used:
0.2 seconds (for 1280x720/24.00P, 1280x720/23.98P or 1280x720/59.94P), 0.25 seconds (for 1280x720/
50.00P) and 0.5 seconds for other video configurations.
• You can press the DISP. button to turn the joystick guide display on and off.
Playing Back MXF Clips
Audio Output
During playback, audio will be available through the × (headphone)
terminal. You can adjust the headphone volume with the [¡ Audio
Setup] > [Audio Output] > [Headphone Volume] setting. The audio
signal will also be output through the HD/SD SDI terminal and the
HDMI OUT terminal.
131
NOTES
• For details on changing the audio channel, refer to Selecting the
× (headphone)
terminal
MXF Clip Operations
MXF Clip Operations
Besides playing back a clip, you can perform other operations such as deleting a clip or displaying clip
information. This is done through the clip menu, which contains different functions depending on the index
screen. You can use the functions in the [w Other Functions] menu to perform some of the operations on all the
clips. Refer to the following table for available functions and refer to the following pages for more details of the
functions.
132
Operating modes:
Clip Menu Functions
Index screen
1
Menu item
Description
A
[$ Mark]/
[% Mark]
[Shot Mark] /
[Expand Clip]
Clip
Ü
Ü
[Display Clip Info]
Displays various information about a clip.
Ü
–
[Add $ Mark]/
[Delete $ Mark]
2
Adds or deletes an $ mark.
Ü
–
[Add % Mark]/
[Delete % Mark]
3
Adds or deletes a % mark.
Ü
Ü
–
2
[Copy Clip]
Copies a clip from one CF card to the other.
Deletes a clip.
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
–
3
[Delete Clip]
Ü
Displays an index screen of all the frames of a clip that
have either shot mark.
[Shot Mark]
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
–
–
–
Displays an index screen of all the frames oclip hat
have the " mark.
[Shot Mark 1]
[Shot Mark 2]
[Expand Clip]
Displays an index screen of all the frames of a clip that
have the # mark.
Displays an index screen that shows frames of a clip at
a fixed interval.
[Delete User Memo]
Deletes the user memo and GPS information of a clip.
Copies the custom picture file from a clip to the camera.
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
–
[Copy / File]
[Add Shot Mark 1]/
[Del. Shot Mark 1]
Adds or deletes a " mark.
–
–
–
–
Ü
Ü
[Add Shot Mark 2]/
[Del. Shot Mark 2]
Adds or deletes a # mark.
4
[Fewer Index Pics]
[More Index Pics]
Decreases the number of thumbnails that are displayed.
Increases the number of thumbnails that are displayed.
–
–
–
–
Ü
4
Ü
Switches to playback of a clip with playback paused on
the selected frame.
[Pause]
–
–
–
–
Ü
Ü
–
[Set Index Picture]
Sets the thumbnail used in the clip index screen.
1
2
3
4
Includes also the [Shot Mark 1] and [Shot Mark 2] index screens.
[$ Mark] index screen only.
[% Mark] index screen only.
[Expand Clip] index screen only.
Using the Clip Menu
1 Select a clip and then press SET.
• The clip menu appears. Available functions depend on the index screen and which functions are enabled.
2 Select the desired function and then press SET.
MXF Clip Operations
• The function is enabled. For some functions, further action may be required. Follow the onscreen directions.
• Press the CANCEL button instead to return to the clip index screen.
IMPORTANT
133
• Observe the following precautions while the CF2 or CF3 access indicator is illuminated in red. Failure to do
so may result in permanent data loss.
- Do not disconnect the power source or turn off the camera.
- Do not open the cover of the either CF card slot.
Displaying Clip Information
Select [Display Clip Info] in the clip menu to display the selected clip’s information screen ([Clip Info] screen).
Push the joystick left/right to switch to the previous/next clip. When you are finished, press the CANCEL button
to return to the clip index screen.
4
5 6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
1
2
3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Thumbnail of the selected clip
Thumbnail of the previous clip
Thumbnail of the next clip
14 Time code of the clip thumbnail
15 Time code of the first frame in clip
16 Time code of the last frame in clip
17 Clip duration
Clip number / Total number of clips
Recording date and time
* When displaying clips that were recorded using slow & fast motion mode, the shooting frame rate and playback frame rate will
both be displayed.
Displaying the Lens Information (2) and User Memo
From the [Clip Info] screen, push the joystick up or turn the SELECT dial up to display the [Lens & Q] screen.
In this screen you can check details about the lens used to record the clip. If the clip has an embedded user
memo, you will see the user memo content in this screen as well. Push the joystick down or turn the SELECT
dial down to return to the [Clip Info] screen.
MXF Clip Operations
Displaying Custom Picture Settings
When displaying the [Clip Info] screen of a clip that has a custom picture file recorded with it, push the joystick
down or turn the SELECT dial down to display the first of three screens with the clip’s custom picture settings
([/ Data 1/3] screen). Push the joystick down or turn the SELECT dial down to switch the [/ Data 2/3] screen
J [/ Data 3/3] screen J [Lens & Q] screen J [Clip Info] screen.
134
Adding $ Marks or % Marks
If you add an OK mark ($) or check mark (%) to a clip, you can later display an index screen that shows only
the clips with an $ mark or only the clips with a % mark. Furthermore, you cannot delete clips with an $ mark
so you can use it to protect important clips.
Adding an $ Mark or % Mark during Playback
To add an OK mark ($) or check mark (%) to a clip during playback or playback pause, you must first set an
assignable button to [Add $ Mark] or [Add % Mark] in advance.
• To add both types of clip marks (to different clips), set one assignable button to [Add $ Mark] and another
assignable button to [Add % Mark].
2 During playback or playback pause, press the assignable button to add the clip mark.
• A message indicating the clip mark will appear and the selected clip mark will be added to the clip.
• Adding a clip mark to a clip during playback will paushe playback.
Adding an $ Mark or % Mark from the Index Screen
1 Select the desired clip and then press SET to open the clip menu.
2 Select [Add $ Mark] or [Add % Mark] and then press SET.
• The clip information screen appears and it prompts you to confirm the operation.
3 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The screen changes back to the clip index screen and an $ mark or % appears next to the selected clip’s
thumbnail.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
NOTES
• A clip cannot have both an $ mark and % mark at the same time. When you add a % mark to a clip with an
$ mark, the $ mark will be deleted. Similarly, when you add an $ mark to a clip with a % mark, the %
mark will be deleted.
Deleting $ Marks or % Marks
Deleting an $ Mark or % Mark from a Clip
1 Select the desired clip and then press SET to open the clip menu.
2 Select [Delete $ Mark] or [Delete % Mark] and then press SET.
• The clip information screen appears and it prompts you to confirm the operation.
3 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The screen changes back to the clip index screen the selected mark is deleted.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
MXF Clip Operations
Deleting $ Marks from All Clips
[w Other Functions]
[Delete All $ Marks]
1 Open the [Delete All $ Marks] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Delete All $ Marks]
2 Select [OK] and then press SET.
135
• All $ marks from clips on the selected CF card will be deleted.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
• While the $ marks are being deleted, you can press SET to cancel.
3 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
Copying Clips
You can copy clips from one CF card to the other. The copied clips will retain their original name.
Copying a Single Clip
1 Select the desired clip and then press SET to open the clip menu.
2 Select [Copy Clip] and then press SET.
• The clip information screen appears and it prompts you to confirm the operation. You can also check the
available space on both CF cards.
3 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
• While the clip is being copied, you can press SEo ancel.
4 When the confirmation message appears, press SE
• The selected clip is copied to the other CF card and the screen changes back to the clip index screen.
Copying All Clips
[w Other Functions]
1 Open the [Copy All Clips] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Clips] > [Copy All Clips]
[Clips]
2 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• All of the clips on the selected CF card will be copied to the other CF
card.
[Copy All Clips]
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
• While the clips are being copied, you can press SET to cancel.
3 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
Copying All Clips with an $ Mark
[w Other Functions]
[Clips]
1 Open the [Copy $ Clips] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Clips] > [Copy $ Clips]
2 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• All of the clips with an $ mark on the selected CF card will be copied
to the other CF card.
[Copy $ Clips]
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
• While the clips are being copied, you can press SET to cancel.
3 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
MXF Clip Operations
NOTES
• You cannot copy a clip if either CF card slot cover is open.
• If a clip is being copied to a card that already has a clip with the same number (the last 4 digits in the clip
name), then the copied clip will be renamed with the following number.
136
Deleting Clips
You can delete any clip except those with an $ mark. To delete such clips, delete the $ mark beforehand.
Deleting a Single Clip
1 Select the desired clip and then press SET to open the clip menu.
2 Select [Delete Clip] and then press SET.
• The clip information screen appears and it prompts you to confirm the operation.
3 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
• While the clip is being deleted, the operation cannot be canceled.
4 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
Deleting All Clips
[w Other Functions]
1 Open the [Delete All Clips] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Clips] > [Delete All Clips
[Clips]
2 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• All of the clips (except for clips with an $ mark) on the selected CF
[Delete All Clips]
card will be deleted.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
• While the clips are being deleted, you can press SET to cancel.
3 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
Deleting the User Memo and GPS Information
1 Select the desired clip and then press SET to open the clip menu.
2 Select [Delete User Memo] and then press SET.
• The [Delete User Memo] screen appears and it prompts you to confirm the operation.
3 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The user memo and GPS information is deleted and the screen changes back to the clip index screen.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
Copying a Custom Picture File Embedded in a Clip
You can copy the custom picture file embedded in a clip to the camera. A custom picture file embedded in a clip
recorded on a CF card with a C300 / C300 PL camcorder can be copied to this camera.
1 Select the desired clip (a clip with the / icon) and then press SET to open the clip menu.
2 Select [Copy / File] and then press SET.
MXF Clip Operations
• The [/ Data 1/3] screen appears with the orange selection frame indicating a custom picture file slot in the
camera.
• Alternatively, you can press the CUSTOM PICTURE button.
• You can push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to display the [/ Data 2/3] and [/ Data 3/3]
screens.
137
3 Push the joystick left/right to select the desired file slot and then press SET.
4 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The custom picture file already in the selected file slot will be overwritten.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
5 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
NOTES
• You cannot copy the custom picture file to a file slot with a protected file.
• By default, file slots [C8] and [C9] are protected.
Displaying an Index Screen of Shot Marks
After you add shot marks to a clip, you can display an index screen that contains all the frames in a clip with
either shot mark, only the " mark or only the # mark. When you play back a clip from this index screen,
playback will start from the frame indicated by the shot mark. ou can also perform other operations from this
index screen, such as adding and deleting shot marks.
1 Select the desired clip and then press SET to n the clip menu.
2 Select [Shot Mark] and then press SET.
• The [Shot Mark] index screen appears, which contains all the frames with shot marks in the clip. Select
instead [Shot Mark 1] to display an index screen only of the frames with the " mark or [Shot Mark 2] to
display an index screen only of the frames with the # mark.
• The time code under the thumbnail indicates the time code of the frame with the shot mark.
• Press the INDEX button or CANCEL button to return to the clip index screen.
Time code of the
frame with the
shot mark
NOTES
• After you finish playing back a clip from this index screen, the index screen that was open before the [Shot
Mark] index screen will appear.
MXF Clip Operations
Displaying a Frame Index Screen of a Single Clip
You can display an index screen of a single clip broken down as frames at fixed intervals. This is useful when you
have a long clip or wish to play back a clip from a certain point. You can change how many thumbnails are
displayed. You can also perform other operations from this index screen, such as adding and deleting shot
marks.
138
1 Select the desired clip and then press SET to open the clip menu.
2 Select [Expand Clip] and then press SET.
• The [Expand Clip] index screen appears, which shows thumbnails of frames taken from the clip at fixed
intervals. The time code under the thumbnail indicates the time code of the frame.
• You can change the fixed interval between frames by showing more or fewer thumbnails. To show more
thumbnails, open the clip menu and select [More Index Pics] and then press SET. To show fewer
thumbnails, select [Fewer Index Pics] and then press SET.
• Press the INDEX button or CANCEL button to return to the clip index screen.
Thumbnail icon:
Indicates the frame
used as the clip
thumbnail in the clip
index screen.
Time code of the
displayed frame
NOTES
• After you finish playing back a clip from this index screen, the index screen that was open before the [Expand
Clip] index screen will appear.
Adding Shot Marks
You can add shot marks (", # or both) to shots in a clip you want to set apart. Later, you can display an index
screen that shows only the clips with a " mark, only the clips with a # mark, or only clips with either shot mark.
Adding Shot Marks during Playback
To add an " mark or # mark to a clip during playback or playback pause, you must first set an assignable
button to [Add Shot Mark 1] or [Add Shot Mark 2] in advance.
2 During playback or playback pause, press the assignable button at the point in the clip to add the
shot mark.
• A message indicating the shot mark appears on the screen and the shot mark is added to the clip.
• Adding a shot mark to a clip during playback will pause the playback.
Adding Shot Marks from the Index Screen
1 Open the [Shot Mark] index screen or [Expand Clip] index screen.
2 Select the desired frame (thumbnail) and then press SET to open the clip menu.
MXF Clip Operations
3 Select [Add Shot Mark 1] or [Add Shot Mark 2] and then press SET.
• The clip information screen appears and it prompts you to confirm the operation.
4 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The screen changes back to the previous index screen and the selected shot mark appears next to the
selected clip’s thumbnail.
139
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
NOTES
• Up to 100 shot marks (" and # marks combined) can be added to a single clip.
• There may be up to a 0.5 second delay from when you press the button to when the camera adds the shot
mark.
Deleting Shot Marks
1 Open the [Shot Mark] index screen or [Expand Clip] index screen.
2 Select the desired frame (thumbnail) and then press SET to open the clip menu.
3 Select [Del. Shot Mark 1] or [Del. Shot Mark 2] and then press SET.
• The clip information screen appears and it prompts you to confirm the operation.
4 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The selected mark is deleted and the screen changes back to the previous index screen.
• If a frame has no shot marks, it will no longer appeathe Shot Mark] index screen.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
Changing a Clip’s Thumbnail
You can change the thumbnail that appears in the clip index screen to a thumbnail of a frame that appears in the
[Shot Mark] index screen or [Expand Clip] index screen.
1 Open the [Shot Mark] index screen or [Expand Clip] index screen.
2 Select the desired frame (thumbnail) and then press SET to open the clip menu.
3 Select [Set Index Picture] and then press SET.
• The clip information screen appears and it prompts you to confirm the operation.
4 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The selected frame is set as the thumbnail and the screen changes back to the previous index screen.
R appears next to the thumbnail of the selected frame.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
NOTES
• When playing back a clip from the clip index screen, playback will start from the beginning of the clip,
regardless of the thumbnail.
MXF Clip Operations
140
External Connections
6
141
Video Output Configuration
The video signal output from the MON. terminals, HD/SD SDI terminal, HDMI OUT terminal and SYNC OUT
terminal depends on the clip’s video configuration, the capability of the external monitor (for video output from
the HDMI OUT terminal) and on various menu settings. The HD/SD SDI terminal, HDMI OUT terminal and SYNC
OUT terminal are able to output the onscreen displays and superimpose them on the picture of an external
Video Configuration and Video Output Configuration for 4K and 2K Modes
Refer to the following tables for the video configuration for recording, video configuration recorded on the CF
card and video output configuration from each terminal during 4K and 2K modes.
Operating modes:
Video configuration
for recording
HD/SD SDI
terminal
4, 5, 6
MON.
terminals
1, 2, 3
System
priority
Recording
3
Resolution
Frame rate
5994P
HD
SD
mode
7
1080/29.97PsF
1080/59.94i
7
1080/29.97 (P/PsF)
1080/23.98 (P/PsF)
1080/25.00 (P/PsF)
480/59.94i
29.97P
23.98P
1080/29.97 (P/PsF)
1080/23.98 (P/PsF)
4096×2160
3840×2160
RAW
7
1080/25.00PsF
1080/50.00i
50.00P
7
576/50.00i
4K
25.00P
24.00P
1080/25.00 (P/PsF)
1080/24.00 (P/PsF)
1080/24.00 (P/PsF)
720/59.94P
–
7
1080/29.97PsF
1080/59.94i
59.94P
50.00P
59.94P
480/59.94i
7
4096×1080
3840×1080
HRAW
7
1080/25.00PsF
720/50.00P
576/50.00i
480/59.94i
7
1080/50.00i
7
1080/29.97PsF
7
1080/59.94i
1080/29.97 (P/PsF)
1080/23.98 (P/PsF)
1080/25.00 (P/PsF)
29.97P
23.98P
1080/29.97 (P/PsF)
1080/23.98 (P/PsF)
12-bit
10-bit
2048×1080
1920×1080
7
1080/25.00PsF
50.00P
7
1080/50.00i
576/50.00i
2K
25.00P
24.00P
1080/25.00 (P/PsF)
1080/24.00 (P/PsF)
1080/24.00 (P/PsF)
720/59.94P
–
7
1080/29.97PsF
1080/59.94i
59.94P
50.00P
480/59.94i
7
2048×1080
1920×1080
7
10-bit
1080/25.00PsF
720/50.00P
576/50.00i
7
1080/50.00i
Video Output Configuration
Video configuration
for recording
HDMI OUT
terminal
SYNC OUT
terminal
5, 8
9
System
priority
Recording mode
Resolution
Frame rate
HD
SD
HD
SD
142
59.94P
29.97P
23.98P
50.00P
25.00P
24.00P
59.94P
50.00P
59.94P
29.97P
23.98P
50.00P
25.00P
24.00P
59.94P
50.00P
1080/59.94i
480/59.94P
1080/59.94i
480/59.94i
4096×2160
3840×2160
RAW
4K
1080/50.00i
576/50.00P
1080/50.00i
576/50.00i
1080/60.00i
720/59.94P
720/50.00P
–
1080/60.00i
720/59.94P
720/50.00P
–
480/59.94P
576/50.00P
480/59.94i
576/50.00i
4096×1080
3840×1080
HRAW
1080/59.94i
480/59.94P
1080/59.94i
480/59.94i
12-bit
10-bit
2048×1080
1920×1080
2K
1080/50.00i
576/50.00P
1080/50.00i
576/50.00i
1080/60.00i
720/59.94P
720/50.00P
–
1080/60.00i
720/59.94P
720/50.00P
–
480/59.94P
576/50.00P
480/59.94i
576/50.00i
2048×1080
1920×1080
10-bit
1
2
The resolution will be set to 1920x1080. When [
4K/2K/MXF Set> [4K (4096/3840)] or [2K (2048/1920)] > [Resolution]
is set to [4096x2160], [4096x1080] or [2048x1080], you can select 48x1080 or 1920x1080 for the output (A 145).
The camera can apply onscreen markers, zebra patterns, peand magnification to the MON. 1 terminal output. The camera
can apply magnification to the MON. 2 terminal output.
3
4
Set [¢ Video Setup] (in
mode) or [
4K/2K/MXF Setup] (in
mode) > [HD/SD SDI] > [Output] to [HD], [SD]
or [Off].
5
6
You can display zebra patterns on an external monitor during HD output (A 83). Zebra patterns will not be output during SD
output.
When the camera is connected via HDMI OUT terminal to an external monitor, the video signal output from the HD/SD SDI
terminal will be the same as that from the HDMI OUT terminal.
When the resolution is 2048x1080, the scan mode is PsF. When the resolution is 1920x1080, the scan mode is interlaced.
Video output will automatically switch to HD or SD, depending on the capability of the external monitor.
7
8
9
Set [¢ Video Setup] (in
component video, luminance signal) or [Composite] (SD analog composite signal).
mode) or [
4K/2K/MXF Setup] (in
mode) > [SYNC OUT] > [Output] to [HD-Y] (HD
Video Output Configuration
Video Output Configuration for MXF Mode
Refer to the following table for the video output configuration from each terminal during recording and playback.
Operating modes:
143
HD/SD SDI
terminal
HDMI OUT
terminal
SYNC OUT
terminal
Video configuration
Resolution Frame rate
2, 3, 4
3, 5
6
HD
HD
SD
HD
SD
HD
SD
(
mode)
(
mode)
59.94i
1080/59.94i
1080/29.97
(P/PsF)
29.97P
1080/59.94i
480/59.94i 1080/59.94i 480/59.94P 1080/59.94i 480/59.94i
576/50.00i 1080/50.00i 576/50.00P 1080/50.00i 576/50.00i
1080/23.98
(P/PsF)
23.98P
50.00i
25.00P
1920×1080
1440×1080
1080/50.00i
1080/50.00i
1080/60.00i
1080/25.00
(P/PsF)
1080/24.00
(P/PsF)
24.00P
–
1080/60.00i
–
1080/60.00i
–
59.94P
29.97P
23.98P
50.00P
25.00P
24.00P
720/59.94P
720/29.97P
720/23.98P
720/50.00P
720/25.00P
720/24.00P
720/59.94P
480/59.94i 720/59.94P 480/59.94P 720/59.94P 480/59.94i
1280×720
720/50.00P
720/60.0P
760.00i 720/50.00P 576/50.00P 720/50.00P 576/50.00i
–
720/60.00P
–
720/60.00P
–
1
2
Set [¢ Video Setup] (in
or [Off].
mode) or [
4K/2K/MXF Setup] (in
mode) > [HD/SD SDI] > [Output] to [HD], [SD]
3
4
You can display zebra patterns on an external monitor during HD output (A 83). Zebra patterns will not be output during SD
output.
When the camera is connected via HDMI OUT terminal to an external monitor, the video signal output from the HD/SD SDI
terminal will be the same as that from the HDMI OUT terminal.
5
6
Video output will automatically switch to HD or SD, depending on the capability of the external monitor.
Set [¢ Video Setup] (in
mode) or [
4K/2K/MXF Setup] (in
mode) > [SYNC OUT] > [Output] to [HD-Y] (HD
component video, luminance signal) or [Composite] (SD analog composite signal).
Connecting to an External Monitor
Connecting to an External Monitor
When you connect the camera to an external monitor for recording or playback, use the terminal on camera that
matches the one you wish to use on the monitor. Then, select the video signal output configuration (A 141).
The camera can output video from all of the video output terminals simultaneously.
144
Operating modes:
Connection Diagram
When you connect the camera to an external monitor using the SYNC OUT terminal, use headphones to monitor
We recommend that you power the camera from a household power outlet using the compact power adapter.
MON. 1 terminal
BNC cable
(commercially
available)
MON. 2 terminal
SYNC OUT
terminal
BNC cable
(commercially
available)
HDMI OUT
terminal
HD/SD SDI
terminal
HDMI cable
(commercially
available)
BNC cable
(commercially
available)
HD SDI IN
VIDEO IN or COMPONENT IN (Y)
HD SDI IN
HDMI IN
HD SDI IN
Connecting to an External Monitor
Using the MON. 1 and MON. 2 Terminals
During 4K and 2K modes, the camera can output video from the MON. 1 and MON. 2 terminals (MON.
terminals). The signal that is output from the MON. terminals also includes audio, time code, metadata and clip
name information. In addition, the camera can apply onscreen markers, zebra patterns, peaking and
magnification* to the MON. 1 terminal output. Perform the following procedures to enable output from the MON.
terminals and to adjust other related settings.
145
* Magnification will simultaneously be applied to the MON. 2 terminal output.
Operating modes:
Enabling Output from the MON. Terminals
[
[
[
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[MON. 1 & 2]
[Output]
1 Open the [Output] submenu.
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [MON. 1 & 2] > [Output]
[
2 Select [On] and then press SET.
• Output is enabled for the MON. terminals.
• If you do not intend to use the MON. terminals, select [Off]. Doing so
will also conserve the camera’s power.
[On]
Selecting the Resolution of the Output
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[MON. 1 & 2]
[Resolution]
When the resolution of the video configuration is [3840x2160],
[3840x1080] or [1920x1080], the resolution of the output is auomatically
set to 1920x1080 so this procedure is not necessary.
1 Open the [Resolution] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [MON. 1 & 2] > [Resolution]
2 Select [2048x1080] or [1920x1080] and then press SET.
[1920x1080]
Selecting the Scan Mode of the Output
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[MON. 1 & 2]
[Scan Mode]
[P]
When the recording mode of the video configuration is [HRAW] or [
10-bit], this procedure is not necessary because this function will be set
automatically based on the resolution.
1 Open the [Scan Mode] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [MON. 1 & 2] > [Scan Mode]
2 Select [P] or [PsF] and then press SET.
Selecting the Resizing Method
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[MON. 1 & 2]
[Resize Output]
[Letterbox]
When the recorded video and video output have a different aspect ratio,
perform the following procedure to select how the video is output.
1 Open the [Resize Output] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [MON. 1 & 2] > [Resize Output]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
Connecting to an External Monitor
Options
[Letterbox]: The picture is reduced in size while maintaining the aspect ratio and black letterbox bars are added to
the top and bottom of the image so that the picture has a 16:9 aspect ratio.
[Squeeze]:
The image is squeezed from the left and right so that the entire image fits within the screen. The image
will appear normal if the external monitor also has a 1.896:1 aspect ratio.
146
[Side Crop]: The left and right sides of the image are cropped so that the central part of the image fits within the
screen.
Original 4K or 2K image
(1.896:1)
[Letterbox] setting
[Squeeze] setting
[Side Crop] setting
NOTES
• For [Letterbox], because the camera uses a simple conversion process vertically, diagonal lines may appear
jagged.
• For MON. terminal output during 4K mode, because the camera uses a simple conversion process, color
shifting may be visible.
• If you set an assignable button to [Resize MON. Output] (A 111), you can press the button to switch the
resizing method.
Applying a LUT to Canon Log Gamma
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[MON. 1 & 2]
[Select]
When checking video recorded with Canon Log gamn an external
monitor connected to a MON. terminal, you can apply a LUT.
1 Open the [Select] submenu (under [LUT]).
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [MON. 1 & 2] > [Select]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
3 Press the LUT button.
[Rec. 709]
• The selected LUT will be applied.
Options
[Rec. 709]:
Converts to a color space based on the ITU-R BT.709 standard.
[Wide DR]: Converts to a wide dynamic range.
Connecting to an External Monitor
Using the HD/SD SDI Terminal
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[HD/SD SDI]
[Output]
The digital signal output from the HD/SD SDI terminal includes the video
signal, audio signal and time code signal. If necessary, perform the
following procedure to change the output to HD or SD*. Turning the
output off will conserve the camera’s power.
147
* Not available for 24.00 Hz recordings.
Operating modes:
[HD]
1 Open the [Output] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] (in
mode) or [¢ Video Setup] (in
mode) > [HD/SD SDI] > [Output]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
• If necessary, adjust the scan mode and resizing method with the [ 4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [HD/SD SDI] >
[Scan Mode] and [ 4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [MON. 1 & 2] > [Resize Output] settings. Depending on the
video configuration, the scan mode may be set automatically.
• If necessary, you can superimpose the onscreen displays on the video displayed on the external monitor
Using the HDMI OUT Terminal
The HDMITM OUT terminal also offers a digital connection d outputs both a video and audio signal. The output
signal will automatically switch to HD or SD* depenon the capability of the external monitor. You can select
* Not available for 24.00 Hz recordings.
NOTES
• Correct operation cannot be guaranteed when connecting the camera to DVI monitors.
• Video may not be output correctly depending on the monitor. In such case, use another terminal.
• The HDMI OUT terminal is output only. Do not connect the camera to another device’s output terminal using
the HDMI OUT terminal as this will cause a malfunction.
• If necessary, you can superimpose the onscreen displays on the video displayed on the external monitor
Using the SYNC OUT Terminal
mode:
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
In addition to its function as a synchronization signal output terminal, you
[
can use the SYNC OUT terminal also as a terminal for analog video signal
output. You can output an HD component video luminance signal or a
down-converted SD composite video signal*.
mode:
[¢ Video Setup]
* Not available for 24.00 Hz recordings.
[SYNC OUT]
[Output]
Operating modes:
1 Open the [Output] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] (in
mode) or [¢ Video Setup] (in
[Composite]
mode) > [SYNC OUT] > [Output]
2 Select [HD-Y] or [Composite] and then press SET.
Connecting to an External Monitor
• If you selected [HD-Y] (HD component video, luminance signal), no more settings are necessary. If you
selected [Composite] (SD analog composite signal), you can select the SD resizing method with the
following procedure.
• If necessary, adjust the scan mode with the [ 4K/2K/MXF Setup] (in
mode) > [SYNC OUT] > [Scan Mode] setting. You can adjust the scan mode only when [¤
TC/UB Setup] > [Time Code] > [24P TC/Sync] is set to [Normal] and the recording mode is set to RAW,
mode) or [¢ Video Setup] (in
148
12-bit or
10-bit.
NOTES
• When you play back a clip on a monitor with a 4:3 aspect ratio, the monitor will switch automatically to
widescreen mode if it is compatible with the Video ID-1 or WSS system.
• If necessary, you can superimpose the onscreen displays on the video displayed on the external monitor
Selecting the Resizing Method for SD Video
mode:
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
When HD video with a 16:9 aspect ratio is converted and output from the
[
HD/SD SDI terminal, HDMI OUT terminal and SYNC OUT terminal as SD
video with a 4:3 aspect ratio, you can choose how it appears on the
external monitor.
mode:
[¢ Video Setup]
Operating modes:
[HD/SD Output]
[Resize SD Output]
[Squeeze]
1 Open the [Resize SD Output] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] (in
mode) or [¢ Video Setup] (in
mode) > [HD/SD Output] > [Resize SD Output]
2 Select the desired option and then press SET.
Options
[Letterbox]: The picture is reduced in size while maintaining the aspect ratio
and black letterbox bars are added to the top and bottom of
the image so that the picture has a 4:3 aspect ratio.
[Squeeze]:
The image is squeezed from the left and right so that the entire
image fits within the screen. The image will appear normal if the
external monitor also has a 16:9 aspect ratio.
[Side Crop]: The left and right sides of the image are cropped so that the
central part of the image fits within the screen.
Original image (16:9)
[Letterbox] setting
[Squeeze] setting
[Side Crop] setting
Connecting to an External Monitor
Superimposing Onscreen Displays to Appear on an
External Monitor
mode:
4K/2K/MXF Setup]
[
You can choose to superimpose onscreen displays on the video output
from the HD/SD SDI terminal, HDMI OUT terminal or SYNC OUT terminal.
Doing so will display the onscreen displays on an external monitor. You
must set this function separately for HD and SD output. This setting will
not affect your recordings.
mode:
[¢ Video Setup]
149
[HD/SD Output]
Operating modes:
[HD Onscreen Disp.]
[SD Onscreen Disp.]
1 Open the [HD Onscreen Disp.] or [SD Onscreen Disp.] submenu.
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] (in
mode) or [¢ Video Setup] (in
[Off]
mode) > [HD/SD Output] > [HD Onscreen Disp.] or [SD Onscreen
Disp.]
2 Select [On] and then press SET.
• T appears on the upper right of the screen (when [£ LCD/VF Setup] > [Custom Display 2] >
[Output Display] is set to [On]).
NOTES
• Onscreen displays will not appear on an external monitor for SD output if [ 4K/2K/MXF Setup] (in
mode) or [¢ Video Setup] (in
mode) > [Resize SD Output] is set to [Side Crop].
• If you set an assignable button to [Onscreen Display] (A 11), you can press the button to turn on and off the
superimposing of onscreen displays on video output frthe camera’s terminals (simultaneously for HD and
SD video).
Developing RAW Clips
Developing RAW Clips
Use the Cinema RAW Development software to develop RAW clips recorded on an external recorder
connected to the camera’s 3G-SDI terminals. After you develop the clips and export them to a full-quality
standard file type such as DPX, they will be ready for color grading. Visit your local Canon Web site to download
the software and receive the latest information on it. Refer to the instruction manual (PDF file) included with the
software for details on its use.
150
Operating modes:
System Requirements
These are the system requirements as of July 2012.
Cinema RAW Development
1
OS
Windows 7 , SP1
Intel® Core i7, 3.06 GHz recommended
NVIDIA GeForce GTX680
Mac OS X v10.7 or 10.8
Intel® Xeon, 2.8 GHz Quad Code recommended
NVIDIA Quadro 4000
CPU
GPU
RAM
16 GB
Any with read/write speed of 600 MB/s
AJA KONA 3G with drivers v10.3.0
2
Hard disk
SDI expansion card
3
AJA KONA 3G with drivers v10.3.1
1
2
3
64-bit version only.
We recommend keeping RAW clips on a separate drive from the save desnation of developed clips.
Required only when checking SDI output on an external monitor.
Installing and Uninstalling Cinema RAW Development (Windows)
Installing Cinema RAW Development
1 Double-click crdw-*****.zip, the file that you downloaded from the Canon Web site, to decompress it.
• The folder crdw-***** will be created that contains the file crdw***.exe.
2 Select your area.
3 Select your country/region and then click Next.
• If you selected Asia or Oceania in step 2, skip to step 5.
4 Select the language to be displayed during installation.
5 After the message appears prompting you to exit other applications, exit other applications and then click OK.
• The software’s license agreement appears.
6 Read the license agreement and click Yes to begin the installation.
• If you do not select Yes, you cannot install the software.
• When the installation has completed, Installation has completed successfully appears.
7 Click Next and then click Finish.
Uninstalling Cinema RAW Development
1 From the Start menu, select All Programs > Canon Utilities > Cinema RAW Development > Uninstall
Cinema RAW Development.
• A confirmation screen appears.
2 Click OK to begin uninstalling the software.
• When the software has been uninstalled, The software has been successfully uninstalled appears.
3 Click OK.
Developing RAW Clips
Installing and Uninstalling Cinema RAW Development (Mac OS)
Installing Cinema RAW Development
1 Double-click crdm-*****.dmg.gz, the file that you downloaded from the Canon Web site, to decompress it.
• The file crdm-*****.dmg will be created.
151
2 Double-click crdm-*****.dmg.
• The crdm*** icon will appear on the desktop.
3 Double-click crdm*** and then double-click CRDInstaller.
4 Select your area.
5 Select your country/region and then click Next.
6 After the message appears prompting you to exit other applications, exit other applications and then click OK.
• The software’s license agreement appears.
7 Read the license agreement and click Yes to begin the installation.
• If you do not select Yes, you cannot install the software.
• When the installation has completed, Installation has completed successfully appears.
8 Click Next and then click Finish.
Uninstalling Cinema RAW Development
1 From Applications, open Canon Utilities.
2 Move Cinema RAW Development to Trash.
Viewing the Software Instruction Manual
For details on using the software, refer to the instruction manual (PDF file*). The instruction manual is installed
with the software.
* Adobe Reader® is required to view the file.
Windows:
1 From the Start menu, select All Programs > Canon Utilities > Cinema RAW Development > Cinema
RAW Development Instruction Manual.
2 Select the language of the instruction manual to view.
Mac OS:
1 From Applications, open Canon Utilities > Cinema RAW Development > Manual.
2 Open the folder of the language and double-click the PDF file.
NOTES
• You can also view the instruction manual by starting the Cinema RAW Development software and then
selecting Help > View Instruction Manual.
Saving MXF Clips to a Computer
Saving MXF Clips to a Computer
Use the software on the supplied Canon XF Utilities CD-ROM to transfer MXF clips recorded on a CF card to a
computer to save them. The CD-ROM contains the following.
152
ቢCanon XF Utility: Browser for transferring clips to a computer, playing back and checking video,
and managing clips.
ባPlugins for non-linear editing (NLE) software: The plugins allow you to transfer clips from a computer
or a CF card (connected via USB reader to a computer) to the NLE software. The following plugins
are included.
- Avid’s NLE software plugins (for computers running Windows or Mac OS)
- Canon XF Plugin for Avid Media Access
- Canon XF Plugin 64 for Avid Media Access
- Apple’s NLE software plugins (for computers running Mac OS)
- Canon XF Plugin for Final Cut Pro
- Canon XF Plugin for Final Cut Pro X
The instruction manual for each module provides more details. Refer to Viewing the Software Instruction
Manuals (A 158) for details on accessing the manuals. Refer to Web sites such as your local Canon Web site
for the latest information on software.
Operating modes:
System Requirements
Canon XF Utility
1
Windows XP , SP3
2
OS
Windows Vista , SP2
Mac OS X v10.5 or 10.6 or 10.7
2
Windows 7 , with or without SP1
Intel® Core
(Intel® Core 2 Duo, 2.66 GHz recommended); SSE2
compatible
Intel® CPU (Intel® Core 2 Duo, 2.66 GHz
recommended)
CPU
RAM
1 GB (2 GB for Windows 7, 64-bit version)
Installation: 80 MB
Available hard disk space
1024 x 768 resolution,
High-color (16-bit color)
1024 x 768 resolution,
32,000 colors
Display
1
2
32-bit version only.
32-bit and 64-bit versions.
Avid’s NLE software plugins
Refer to the following for the required applications.
Media Composer 4.0.5 / 5.0 / 5.5 (Windows and Mac OS)
NewsCutter 8.0.5 / 9.0 / 9.5 (Windows only)
Media Composer 6.0 (Windows and Mac OS)
NewsCutter 10.0 (Windows only)
Canon XF Plugin for Avid Media Access
Canon XF Plugin 64 for Avid Media Access
Refer to the application’s official home page for the application’s system requirements.
Saving MXF Clips to a Computer
Apple’s NLE software plugins
Refer to the following for the required applications.
Canon XF Plugin for Final Cut Pro
Canon XF Plugin for Final Cut Pro X
Final Cut Pro 6.0.6 / 7.0.0 to 7.0.3
Final Cut Pro X 10.0.3
153
Refer to the application’s official home page for the application’s system requirements.
NOTES
• Even if your computer meets the system requirements, proper operation of the software cannot be
guaranteed.
Installing and Uninstalling Canon XF Utility (Windows)
Installing Canon XF Utility
Perform the following procedure to install the Canon XF Utility software. Note that you can select the language
used for the installation process from English, French, Spanish, Italian or German (available languages depend
on the region you select).
1 Insert the Canon XF Utilities CD-ROM into the computer.
• The installation screen appears. If it does not, follow the steps below.
- Windows Vista and Windows 7: When the AutoPlawindow appears, select Run SETUP.EXE.
- Windows Vista, Windows 7 and Windows XPpeComputer (Windows Vista and Windows 7) or My
Computer (Windows XP) and double-click thn of the drive that contains the CD-ROM.
2 Select your region.
• If you selected Asia or Oceania, skip to step 4.
3 Select the language to be displayed during installation.
Saving MXF Clips to a Computer
4 Select an installation method and then click OK.
• If you selected the Easy Installation installation method, skip to step 7.
154
5 Select the software to install and the destination folder. Then, click Next.
6 Click Install.
7 Read the license agreement and click Yes to begin the installation.
• If you do not select Yes, you cannot install the software.
• When the installation has completed, Installation has completed successfully appears.
• You can click Cancel to cancel the operation.
8 Click Next and then click Finish.
9 Remove the CD-ROM from the computer.
Uninstalling Canon XF Utility
1 From the Start menu, select All Programs > Canon Utilities > Canon XF Utility > Uninstall Canon XF Utility.
• A confirmation screen appears.
2 Click Yes to begin the uninstalling the software.
• When the software has been uninstalled, The software has been successfully uninstalled appears.
3 Click OK.
Saving MXF Clips to a Computer
Uninstalling Canon XF Plugin for Avid Media Access or Canon XF Plugin 64 for Avid Media
Access
1 In the Control Panel, open Programs and Features* (Windows Vista/Windows 7) or Add or Remove
Programs (Windows XP).
155
• A list of installed programs appears.
2 Select the desired plugin.
3 Click Uninstall or Uninstall/Change (Windows Vista/Windows 7) or Change/Remove (Windows XP).
4 Follow the onscreen instructions.
* This may be Add or Remove Programs depending on how the Control Panel is displayed.
Uninstalling Canon XF MPEG2 Decoder
1 In the Control Panel, open Programs and Features* (Windows Vista/Windows 7) or Add or Remove
Programs (Windows XP).
• A list of installed programs appears.
2 Select Canon XF MPEG2 Decoder.
3 Click Uninstall or Uninstall/Change (Windows Vista/Windows 7) or Change/Remove (Windows XP).
4 Follow the onscreen instructions.
* This may be Add or Remove Programs depending on how the Control Panel is displayed.
Uninstalling the Instructions for Avid’s NLE Software Plugins
1 From the Start menu, open All Programs > Canon Uies > Desired plugin > Uninstall Canon XF Plugin
for Avid Media Access Instruction Manual or Cn XF Plugin 64 for Avid Media Access Instruction
Manual.
2 When the confirmation screen appears, click Yes and then click OK.
Installing and Uninstalling Canon XF Utility (Mac OS)
Installing Canon XF Utility
1 Insert the Canon XF Utilities CD-ROM into the computer.
2 Open the Finder, click CanonXF**M under DEVICES in the sidebar and double-click MasterInstaller.
• The “**” in the CD-ROM’s name stands for the version number.
• Mac OS X v10.5 or 10.6: The CD-ROM’s icon will appear on the desktop. You can double click the icon and
then double-click MasterInstaller.
• The installation screen appears.
3 Select your region.
Saving MXF Clips to a Computer
4 Click Install.
156
5 Select the installation method and then click Next.
6 Read the license agreement and click Agree.
• If you do not select Agree, you cannot install the software.
• If you selected the Easy Installation installation method, skip to step 8.
7 Select the software to install and then click Next.
Saving MXF Clips to a Computer
8 Click Next to begin the installation.
157
• When the installation has completed, Installation has finished. appears.
9 Click Finish and then remove the CD-ROM from the computer.
Uninstalling the Software
1 From Applications, open Canon Utilities.
2 Move Canon XF Utility to Trash.
Uninstalling Canon XF Plugin for Final Cut Pro
Move the following file to Trash.
/Library/Application Support/ProApps/MIO/RAD/Pns/CanonXF.RADPlug
Uninstalling Canon XF Plugin for Final Cut Pro X
Move the following file to Trash.
/Library/Application Support/ProApps/MIO/RADPlugins/CanonXF64.RADPlug
Uninstalling Canon XF Plugin for Avid Media Access
Move the following file to Trash.
/Library/Application Support/Avid/AVX2_Plug-ins/AMA/MVP_CanonXF.avx
Uninstalling Canon XF Plugin 64 for Avid Media Access
Move the following file to Trash.
/Library/Application Support/Avid/AVX2_Plug-ins/AMA/MVP_CanonXF64.avx
Uninstalling Canon XF MPEG2 Decoder
Move the following file to Trash.
/Library/QuickTime/XFMpeg2Dec.component
Uninstalling the Instructions for Apple’s NLE Software Plugins
1 From Applications, open Canon Utilities.
2 Move Canon XF Plugin for Final Cut Pro or Canon XF Plugin for Final Cut Pro X to Trash.
Uninstalling the Instructions for Avid’s NLE Software Plugins
1 From Applications, open Canon Utilities.
Saving MXF Clips to a Computer
2 Move Canon XF Plugin for Avid Media Access or Canon XF Plugin 64 for Avid Media Access to Trash.
158
Viewing the Software Instruction Manuals
For details on using the software, refer to the instruction manual (PDF file) of each module. The instruction
manuals are installed with the software. For computers running Windows, Adobe® Reader® is required.
Viewing the Canon XF Utility Instruction Manual
Windows:
1 From the Start menu, select All Programs > Canon Utilities > Canon XF Utility > Canon XF Utility
Instruction Manual.
2 Select the language of the instruction manual to view.
Mac OS:
1 From Applications, open Canon Utilities > Canon XF Utility > Manual.
2 Open the folder of the language and double-click the PDF file.
You can also view the instruction manual by starting the Canon XF Utility software and then selecting Help >
View Instruction Manual.
Viewing the Instructions for the NLE Software Plugins
Windows:
1 From the Start menu, select All Programs > Canon tilities > Desired plugin > Canon XF Plugin for Avid
Media Access Instruction Manual or Canon XF Plugin 64 for Avid Media Access Instruction Manual.
2 Select the desired language.
Mac OS:
1 From Applications, open Canon Utilities > Desired plugin > Manual.
2 Open the folder of the language and double-click the PDF file.
Photos
7
159
Taking Photos
You can take photos when the camera is in
camera is in
mode or you can capture a photo from an MXF clip when the
mode. Photos are saved onto the SD card. In
mode, photo size is 1920x1080*. In
mode, photo size depends on the resolution setting of the clip that the photo is captured from. If the clip
is 1920x1080 or 1440x1080, the photo size is 1920x1080. If the clip is 1280x720, the photo size is 1280x720.
* At this size, the camera can save approximately 670 photos on a 1 GB SD card. Also, during 4K and 2K modes, if [
4K/2K/MXF
Setup] > [Resize MXF Output] is set to [Letterbox], the picture angle will differ.
Taking Photos in CAMERA Mode
You can take a photo while the camera is recording a clip or is in record pause mode. If a custom picture file is
selected in advance, it will be recorded with the photo (A 114). To take a photo, set an assignable button to
[Photo] in advance.
Operating modes:
2 Press the assignable button to take a photo.
• * and the number of available photos appear he upper right of the screen.
• If a custom picture file is selected, it will be recorded with the photo.
• The SD card access indicator will flash as the photo is being recorded.
NOTES
• Photo recording is disabled while Wi-Fi communication is turned on ([w Other Functions] > [Wi-Fi Remote]
> [Select] is set to a setting other than [Off]).
Capturing Photos in MEDIA Mode
You can capture a photo from an MXF clip during playback pause. To capture a photo, set an assignable button
to [Photo] in advance.
Operating modes:
2 Select the desired MXF clip and press the Ò button to start playback.
3 Pause the playback at the point you want to capture.
4 Press the assignable button to capture a photo.
• The screen will momentarily turn black as if a camera shutter had released.
• * and the number of available photos appear on the upper right of the screen.
• The SD card access indicator will flash as the photo is being recorded.
5 Press the Ñ button to stop playback.
Taking Photos
IMPORTANT
• Observe the following precautions while the SD card access indicator is flashing. Failure to do so may result in
permanent data loss.
- Do not disconnect the power source or turn off the camera.
- Do not remove the SD card.
160
NOTES
• If the LOCK switch on the SD card is set to prevent writing, you will not be able to record a photo. Change the
position of the LOCK switch in advance.
• Even if [Other Functions] > [Custom Function] > [Scan Reverse Rec] is set to a setting other than [Off],
photos will not be inverted.
Photo Playback
Photo Playback
You can view the photos that you took with the camera.
Operating modes:
161
Displaying the [Photos] Index Screen
Display the [Photos] index screen to view photos.
1 Set the Q switch to MEDIA.
• The camera switches to
appears.
mode and the clip index screen
2 Press the INDEX button.
• The index screen selection menu appears.
3 Select [Photo Index] and then press SET.
• The [Photos] index screen appears.
• After you are finished viewing photos, press the INDEX button to
return to the clip index screen.
Viewing Photos
1 Move the orange selection frame to the desired photo.
2 Press the Ò button to view the photo.
• The photo playback screen appears and the selected photo is
displayed.
• Use the Ú/Ù buttons or push the joystick left/right to switch to
the previous/next photo.
• Press the DISP. button to hide/show the onscreen displays.
• Press the Ñ button to return to the [Photos] index screen.
IMPORTANT
• Observe the following precautions while the SD card access indicator is flashing. Failure to do so may result in
permanent data loss.
- Do not disconnect the power source or turn off the camera.
- Do not remove the SD card.
NOTES
• The following photos may not be displayed correctly.
- Photos not recorded with this camera.
- Photos created or edited on a computer.
- Photos whose file names have been changed.
Photo Operations
Photo Operations
You can use the photo menu to delete a photo, protect or unprotect a photo, or copy a custom picture file
embedded in a photo. You can display the photo menu from the [Photos] index screen or photo playback
screen.
162
Using the Photo Menu
1 From the [Photos] index screen, select a photo and then press SET.
• If you are viewing a photo, simply press SET.
• The photo menu appears. Available functions depend on the photo’s settings.
2 Select the desired function and then press SET.
Deleting Photos
You can delete a photo you no longer need. When you do so, however, the custom picture file embedded in it
will also be deleted. Photos can be deleted one at a time from the photo playback screen or [Photos] index
screen.
Operating modes:
Deleting a Photo from the Playback Screen
2 Press SET to open the photo menu.
3 Select [Delete] and then press SET.
• The screen prompts you to confirm the operation.
4 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
• The selected photo is deleted and the next photo is displayed.
• If a custom picture file is embedded in the photo, it is also deleted.
5 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
Deleting a Photo from the Index Screen
2 Move the orange selection frame to the photo to be deleted.
3 Press SET to open the photo menu.
4 Select [Delete] and then press SET.
• The screen prompts you to confirm the operation.
5 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
• The selected photo is deleted.
• If a custom picture file is embedded in the photo, it is also deleted.
6 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
Photo Operations
Deleting All Photos
[w Other Functions]
[Delete All Photos]
2 Open the [Delete All Photos] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Delete All Photos]
163
3 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• All of the photos on the SD card, except for protected ones, will be deleted.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
• While the photos are being deleted, you can press SET to cancel.
4 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
IMPORTANT
• Be careful when deleting photos. Deleted photos cannot be recovered.
Protecting Photos
You can protect photos to prevent accidental erasure. The custom picture file embedded in such a photo is also
protected. Photos can be protected from the photo playback screen or [Photos] index screen.
Operating modes:
Protecting a Photo from the Playback Screen
2 Press SET to open the photo menu.
3 Select [Protect] and then press SET.
• To remove protection settings from a protected photo, select [Unprotect] instead.
• The screen prompts you to confirm the operation.
4 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
• The selected photo is protected and i appears on the lower left of the screen.
• If a custom picture file is embedded in the photo, it is also protected.
Protecting a Photo from the Index Screen
2 Move the orange selection frame to the photo to be protected.
3 Press SET to open the photo menu.
4 Select [Protect] and then press SET.
• To remove protection settings from a protected photo, select [Unprotect] instead.
• The screen prompts you to confirm the operation.
5 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The selected photo is protected and i appears next to the photo’s thumbnail.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
• If a custom picture file is embedded in the photo, it is also protected.
Photo Operations
IMPORTANT
• Initializing an SD card will permanently erase all the data it contains, including protected photos and custom
picture files.
164
Copying Custom Picture Files
You can copy to the camera a custom picture file embedded in a photo. Custom picture files can be copied from
the photo playback screen or [Photos] index screen. A custom picture file embedded in a photo recorded on an
SD card with a C300 / C300 PL camcorder can be copied to this camera.
Operating modes:
Copying a File from the Playback Screen
2 Press SET to open the photo menu.
3 Select [Copy / File] and then press SET.
• The [/ Data 1/3] screen appears with the orange selection frame indicating a file slot in the camera.
• Alternatively, you can press the CUSTOM PICTURE button.
• You can push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to display the [/ Data 2/3] and [/ Data 3/3]
screens.
4 Push the joystick left/right to select the desired file sot ad then press SET.
5 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The custom picture file embedded in the selected photo is copied, overwriting the file in that slot.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
6 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
Copying a File from the Index Screen
2 Move the orange selection frame to the photo with the custom picture file to be copied.
3 Press SET to open the photo menu.
4 Select [Copy / File] and then press SET.
• The [/ Data 1/3] screen appears with the orange selection frame indicating a file slot in the camera.
• Alternatively, you can press the CUSTOM PICTURE button.
• You can push the joystick up/down or turn the SELECT dial to display the [/ Data 2/3] and [/ Data 3/3]
screens.
5 Push the joystick left/right to select the desired file slot and then press SET.
6 Select [OK] and then press SET.
• The custom picture file embedded in the selected photo is copied, overwriting the file in that slot.
• Select [Cancel] instead to cancel the operation.
7 When the confirmation message appears, press SET.
NOTES
• You cannot copy the custom picture file to a file slot with a protected file.
• By default, file slots [C8] and [C9] are protected.
Photo Operations
Photo Numbering
[w Other Functions]
Photos are automatically assigned consecutive numbers from 0101 to
9900, and stored on the SD card in folders containing up to 100 photos.
Folders are numbered from 101 to 998. You can select the photo
numbering method to be used.
[Photo Numbering]
[Continu.]
165
The photo number indicates the name and location of the file on the SD
card. For example, a photo numbered 101-0107 is located in the
“DCIM\101CANON” folder as the file “IMG_0107.jpg”.
Operating modes:
1 Open the [Photo Numbering] submenu.
[w Other Functions] > [Photo Numbering]
2 Select the desired option and the press SET.
Options
[Reset]:
Photo numbers will restart from 101-0101 every time you insert a new SD card. If an SD card already
contains photos, photo numbers will continue from the number following that of the last photo on the SD
card.
[Continu.]: Photo numbers will continue from the number following that of the last photo recorded with the camera.
NOTES
• If you select [Continu.] and the SD card you insert alreacontains a photo with a larger number, a new photo
will be assigned a number one higher than that of e lat photo on the SD card.
• We recommend using the [Continu.] setting.
Photo Operations
166
Additional Information
8
167
Menu Options
For details about how to select an item, refer to Using the Menus (A 31). For details about each function, see
the reference page. Menu items without a reference page are explained after the tables. Setting options in
boldface indicate default values. Menu items not available appear grayed out.
To skip directly to the page of a specific menu:
[~ Camera Setup] menu
4K/2K/MXF Setup] menu
[¢ Video Setup] menu
A 167
A 167
A 170
A 171
A 171
A 174
A 174
A 175
A 177
[
[¡ Audio Setup] menu
[£ LCD/VF Setup] menu
[¤ TC/UB Setup] menu
[¤ User Bit Setup] menu
[w Other Functions] menu
[¥My Menu] customized menu
[~ Camera Setup] menu (
mode only)
Menu item
Submenu
Setting options
A
[ISO/Gain]
[Select]
[ISGai
[ISO Increment]
[Gain]
[1 s1/3 stop]
[Normal], [Fine]
2 [Iris]
[Iris Increment]
[Zoom-Iris Correct.]
[Mode]
[1/2 stop], [1/3 stop], [Fine]
[On], [Off]
[Shutter]
[Speed], [Angle], [Clear Scan], [Slow], [Off]
[1/3 stop], [1/4 stop]
[On], [Off]
[Shutter Increment]
[/ CINEMA Locked]
[ABB]
[Cancel], [OK]
[Color Bars]
[Enable]
[Type]
[On], [Off]
[SMPTE], [EBU], [ARIB]
[On], [Off]
2 [Periph. Illum. Corr.]
[
4K/2K/MXF Setup] menu (
mode only)
Menu item
[System Priority]
Submenu
Setting options
A
[4K], [2K], [MXF]
[59.94 Hz], [50.00 Hz] , [24.00 Hz]
1
[System Frequency]
Menu Options
Menu item
Submenu
Setting options
A
2
[4K (4096/3840)]
[Mode]
[RAW], [HRAW]
2
[Resolution]
When [Mode] is set to [RAW]:
[4096x2160], [3840x2160]
When [Mode] is set to [HRAW]:
[4096x1080], [3840x1080]
168
2
[Frame Rate]
For 59.94 Hz recordings:
[59.94P], [29.97P], [23.98P]
For 50.00 Hz recordings:
[50.00P], [25.00P]
For 24.00 Hz recordings, the frame rate is set to [24.00P] and cannot be
changed.
3
8
[2K (2048/1920)]
[Mode]
[
12-bit], [
10-bit], [
10-bit]
3
[Resolution]
[2048x1080], [1920x1080]
3
[Frame Rate]
For 59.94 Hz recordings:
[59.94P], [29.97P], [23.98P]
For 50.00 Hz recordings:
[50.00P], [25.00P]
For 24.00 Hz recordings, the frame rate is set to [24.00P] and cannot be
changed.
4
[MXF]
[Bit Rate/Resolution]
[50 Mbps 1920x1080], [50 Mbps 1280x720], [35 Mbps 1920x1080],
[35 Mbps 1280x720], [25 Mbps 1440x1080]
4, 5, 6
[Frame Rate]
For 59.94 Hz recodings:
[59.94i.94P], [29.97P], [23.98P]
For 50 Hrecordings:
[5, [50.00P], [25.00P]
For 24.00 Hz recordings, the frame rate is set to [24.00P] and cannot be
changed.
7
[Resize MXF Output]
[Special Rec]
[Letterbox], [Squeeze], [Side Crop]
5
[Interval Rec], [Frame Rec], [Pre Rec] , [Slow & Fast Motion], [Off]
[Interval Rec]
[Interval]
[1 sec] to [10 sec], [15 sec], [20 sec], [30 sec], [40 sec], [50 sec],
[1 min] to [10 min]
[Rec Frames]
During 4K or 2K mode, or MXF mode when [Frame Rate] is set to [59.94i],
[29.97P], [23.98P] or [24.00P]:
1, 3, 6, 9
During MXF mode when [Frame Rate] is set to [59.94P], [50.00i], [50.00P]
or [25.00P]:
2, 6 ,12
[Frame Rec]
[Rec Frames]
During 4K or 2K mode, or MXF mode when [Frame Rate] is set to [59.94i],
[29.97P], [23.98P] or [24.00P]:
1, 3, 6, 9
During MXF mode when [Frame Rate] is set to [59.94P], [50.00i], [50.00P]
or [25.00P]:
2, 6 ,12
Menu Options
Menu item
Submenu
Setting options
During 4K mode when [Mode] is set to [RAW], or 2K mode when [Mode] is
set to [ 12-bit] or [ 10-bit]:
A
[S&F Frame Rate]
For 59.94 Hz and 24.00 Hz recordings:
[1] to [30], [32] to [60]* ([24])
For 50.00 Hz recordings:
169
[1] to [25], [26] to [50]* ([24])
During 4K mode when [Mode] is set to [HRAW], or 2K mode when [Mode]
is set to [
10-bit]:
For 59.94 Hz and 24.00 Hz recordings:
[1] to [60], [62] to [120]* ([24])
For 50.00 Hz recordings:
[1] to [50], [52] to [100]* ([24])
During MXF mode when [Bit Rate/Resolution] is set to an option with 1080
vertical resolution:
For 59.94 Hz and 24.00 Hz recordings:
[1] to [30]
For 50.00 Hz recordings:
[1] to [25]
During MXF mode when [Bit Rate/Resolution] is set to an option with 720
vertical resolution:
For 59.94 Hz and 24.00 Hz recordings:
[1] to [60], ([30])
For 50.00 Hz recordings:
[1] to [50], (25])
* This rais in 2 fps increments. When the shooting frame
rppars in brackets on the screen, this indicates that
bG-SDI terminals are required for output.
[Clip Name]
[Metadata]
[Title Prefix]
Two characters, each:
[A] to [Z], [0] to [9] ([AA])
–
–
[Number Setting]
[Setting]
[Set], [Reset] ([0001])
[Remote], [SD Card]
[User Memo]
[Country Code]
[Organization]
[User Code]
[Off], list of user memo files available on the SD card
Letters A to Z, numbers 0 to 9, plus sign (+), minus sign (-), colon (:),
space
–
7
[3G-SDI Output]
[On], [Off]
7
[MON. 1 & 2]
[Output]
[On], [Off]
[LUT]
[On], [Off]
[Select]
[Rec. 709], [Wide DR]
[2048x1080], [1920x1080]
[Letterbox], [Squeeze], [Side Crop]
[P], [PsF]
[Resolution]
[Resize Output]
6
[Scan Mode]
7
[MON. 1]
[Peaking Gain]
[Output]
[Off], [1] to [15] ([10])
8
[HD/SD SDI]
[HD], [SD] , [Off]
[Scan Mode]
[P], [PsF]
8
8
[SYNC OUT]
[Output]
[HD-Y], [HD Sync], [Blk Burst] , [Composite] , [Off]
[Scan Mode]
[P], [PsF]
[HD/SD Output]
[HD Onscreen Disp.]
[Zebra HD Output]
[SD Onscreen Disp.]
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
8
[Resize SD Output]
[Letterbox], [Squeeze], [Side Crop]
Menu Options
Menu item
Submenu
Setting options
A
[Rec Command]
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
–
[Set CF Card Slot]
[Relay Rec]
[Double Slot Rec]
170
1
The default value depends on the country/region or purchase.
Available during 4K mode only.
Available during 2K mode only.
Available options depend on the system priority and system frequency settings.
Available during MXF mode only.
Available options depend on the system frequency and resolution settings.
Available during 4K and 2K modes only.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Not available for 24.00 Hz recordings.
[Clip Name] settings
[Title Prefix]: Determines the first 2 characters of the clip name. Combined with the [Number Setting] setting,
this constitutes the 6-character clip name.
[Number Setting]: Determines the last 4 digits of the clip name. Combined with the [Title Prefix] setting, this
constitutes the 6-character clip name. Select [Set] to assign a desired number to the first clip you record or
select [Reset] to reset the number to [0001].
The numerals increase every time a clip is recorded.
[Country Code]: This identifier is the country code defined by ISO-3166-1 and is to be entered starting from
the left.
[Organization]: This identifier represents the organization that owns or operates the camera and can be
obtained by registering with the SMPTE Registration Authrity. f the organization is not registered, enter [0000].
[User Code]: This identifier designates the user. Leathiblank if [Organization] is set to [0000].
[Rec Command]: When you connect the camera to another device using the 3G-SDI terminals (during 4K and
2K modes) or HD/SD SDI terminal (during MXF mode), if you start or stop recording with the camera, the other
device will also start or stop recording.
[¢ Video Setup] menu (
mode only )
Menu item
Submenu
Setting options
A
1
[System Frequency]
[59.94 Hz], [50.00 Hz] , [24.00 Hz]
62,
2
[HD/SD SDI]
[SYNC OUT]
[Output]
[Scan Mode]
[HD], [SD] , [Off]
[P], [PsF]
2
2
[Output]
[HD-Y], [HD Sync], [Blk Burst] , [Composite] , [Off]
[Scan Mode]
[P], [PsF]
[HD/SD Output]
[HD Onscreen Disp.]
[SD Onscreen Disp.]
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
2
[Resize SD Output]
[Letterbox], [Squeeze], [Side Crop]
1
2
The default value depends on the country/region of purchase.
Not available for 24.00 Hz recordings.
Menu Options
[¡ Audio Setup] menu
Menu item
Submenu
[XLR Rec Channel]
[XLR1 Mic Trimming]
[XLR2 Mic Trimming]
[XLR1 Mic Att.]
Setting options
[CH1], [CH1/CH2]
A
[Audio Input]
Ü
Ü
–
–
[+12 dB], [+6 dB], [0 dB], [-6 dB], [-12 dB]
171
[On], [Off]
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
–
–
[XLR2 Mic Att.]
[XLR ALC Link]
[Linked], [Separated]
[Limiter]
[On], [Off]
[1 kHz Tone]
[MIC Mode]
[MIC Level]
[-12 dB], [-18 dB], [-20 dB], [Off]
[Automatic], [Manual]
0 to 99 (50)
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
–
–
[MIC Att.]
[On], [Off]
–
[Audio Output]
[Channel]
[CH1/CH2], [CH1/CH1], [CH2/CH2], [All/All]
[Off], 1 to 15 (8)
Ü*
Ü*
[Headphone Volume]
* Not available in the [Photos] index screen.
[£ LCD/VF Setup] menu
Menu item
[LCD Setup]
Submenu
Stting options
-99 to 99 )
-9( 0)
-20 to 20 ( 0)
1 to 4 (2)
A
[Brightness]
[Contrast]
[Color]
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
[Sharpness]
[Backlight]
[Brightness]
[Contrast]
[Color]
[Normal], [Bright]
-99 to 99 ( 0)
-99 to 99 ( 0)
-20 to 20 ( 0)
1 to 4 (2)
[VF Setup]
[Sharpness]
[Backlight]
[Normal], [Bright]
[On], [Off]
[LCD/VF B&W]
[LCD/VF Simul.]
[View Assist.]
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
1
[Peaking]
[On], [Off]
–
1
[Select]
[Peaking 1], [Peaking 2]
[White], [Red], [Yellow], [Blue]
[Off], 1 to 15 (8)
1 to 4 (2)
–
1
[Peaking 1]
[Color]
–
[Gain]
–
[Frequency]
–
1
1
[Peaking 2]
[Color]
[White], [Red], [Yellow], [Blue]
[Off], 1 to 15 (15)
1 to 4 (1)
–
[Gain]
–
[Frequency]
–
Menu Options
Menu item
Submenu
Setting options
A
1
[Zebra]
[On], [Off]
Ü
Ü
–
–
1
[Select]
[Zebra 1], [Zebra 2], [Zebra 1&2]
1
1
[Zebra 1 Level]
[70 5%], [75 5%], [80 5%], [85 5%],
[90 5%], [95 5%]
172
Ü
Ü
–
–
[Zebra 2 Level]
[70%], [75%], [80%], [85%], [90%], [95%],
[100%]
1
[Markers]
[Enable]
[Center]
[On], [Off]
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
[White], [Gray], [Off]
[White], [Gray], [Off]
[White], [Gray], [Off]
[White], [Gray], [Off]
[80%], [90%], [92.5%], [95%]
[White], [Gray], [Off]
[Horizontal]
[Grid]
[Safety Zone]
[Safety Zone Area]
[Aspect Marker]
[Aspect Ratio]
[4:3], [13:9], [14:9], [1.66:1], [1.75:1],
[1.85:1], [2.35:1]
Ü
–
2
[Audio Level]
[On], [Off]
–
Ü
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
[Custom Display 1]
[Custom Picture]
2 [Focal Length]
[ND Filter]
[On], [Off]
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
[Key Lock]
[On], [Off]
[White Balance]
2 [Iris]
[On], [Off]
[On]
–
[ISO/Gain]
[On], [Off]
[Shutter]
[On], [Off]
[Peaking]
[On], [Off]
[Magnification]
[View Assist.]
[Lens]
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
[Custom Display 2]
[Remaining Battery]
[Remaining Rec Time]
[Rec Mode]
[Warning], [Normal], [Off]
[Warning], [Normal], [Off]
[On], [Off]
[Genlock]
[On], [Off]
[Time Code]
[On], [Off]
[Interval Counter]
[SD Card Status]
[Temperature/Fan]
[4K/2K Mode]
[Bit Rate]
[On], [Off]
[Warning], [Normal], [Off]
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
–
[On], [Off]
[Resolution]
[On], [Off]
[Frame Rate]
[Character Rec]
[Output Display]
[Rec Command]
[User Memo]
[User Bit]
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
[On], [Off]
[Audio Output CH]
[On], [Off]
Menu Options
Menu item
Submenu
[Audio Level]
Setting options
A
[Custom Display 2]
[On], [Off]
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
–
[Wi-Fi]
[On], [Off]
–
–
–
[Date/Time]
[Date/Time]
[Camera Data]
[Date/Time], [Time], [Date], [Off]
[On], [Off]
–
173
2
2
[Metadata Display]
Ü
Ü
[On], [Off]
–
1
2
Setting applies also to the MON. 1 terminal output.
Not available in the [Photos] index screen or photo playback screen.
[Audio Level]: Displays the audio level meter when set to [On].
[Custom Display 1] settings
[Custom Picture]: Displays the custom picture icon (/) when set to [On], indicating that a custom picture
profile will be recorded with a clip.
2 [Focal Length]: Displays the current focal length of an attached EF lens when set to [On].
[ND Filter]: Displays the ND filter indicator when set to [On].
[Key Lock]: Displays the key lock icon (C) when set to [On].
[White Balance]: Displays the white balance indicator when set to [On].
2 [Iris]: Displays the aperture setting when set to [On].
[ISO/Gain]: Displays the ISO speed or gain setting when set to [On].
[Shutter]: Displays the shutter speed setting when set to [On
[Peaking]: Displays the peaking icon (J or K) whn set to [On].
[Magnification]: Displays the screen magnification i(^) when set to [On], indicating that the image on
the screen is being magnified.
[View Assist.]: Displays the view assistance icon (O) when set to [On].
[Lens]: Displays the lens warning icon (
) when set to [On], indicating that the attached lens cannot
communicate with the camera.
[Custom Display 2] settings
[Remaining Battery]: Controls when the remaining battery indicator appears.
[Warning]: Appears only when there is a warning.
[Normal]: Always appears on the screen.
[Remaining Rec Time]: Displays the remaining recording time.
[Warning]: Appears only when there is a warning.
[Normal]: Always appears on the screen.
[Rec Mode]: Displays the recording operation indicator ([STBY`] in record pause mode, for example) when
set to [On].
[Genlock]: Displays the Genlock synchronization icon (U) when set to [On].
[Time Code]: Displays the time code when set to [On].
[Interval Counter]: Displays the countdown during interval recording mode when set to [On].
[SD Card Status]: Controls when the SD card status indicator appears.
[Warning]: Appears only when there is a warning.
[Normal]: Always appears on the screen.
[Temperature/Fan]: Displays the temperature warning icon ( ) and the cooling fan icon (
) when set to
[On]. The temperature warning icon indicates that the camera’s internal temperature has become high.
[4K/2K Mode]: Displays the recording mode onscreen display for 4K mode ([RAW] or [HRAW]) or 2K mode
(
or
, plus bit depth) when set to [On].
Menu Options
[Bit Rate]: Displays the bit rate when set to [On].
[Resolution]: Displays the resolution when set to [On].
[Frame Rate]: Displays the frame rate when set to [On].
174
[Character Rec]: Displays the character recording warning icon (S) when set to [On], indicating that the
onscreen displays will be recorded on the clip.
[Output Display]: Displays the output display warning icon (T) when set to [On], indicating that the
onscreen displays will be output to an external monitor.
[Rec Command]: Displays the status of the recording command that is being output when [ 4K/2K/MXF
Setup] > [Rec Command] is set to [On].
[User Memo]: Displays the user memo icon (Q) when set to [On], indicating that a user memo will be
recorded with a clip.
[User Bit]: Displays the user bit when set to [On].
[Audio Output CH]: Displays the audio output channel when set to [On].
[Audio Level]: Displays the audio level indicator and, if activated, the audio peak limiter icon (æ) when set to [On].
[Wi-Fi]: Displays the Wi-Fi icon („) when set to [On].
[Date/Time]: Displays the date and/or time.
[Metadata Display]: Displays the date and time of recording and/or the camera data (shutter speed, aperture
value, gain) during playback of an MXF clip.
[¤ TC/UB Setup] menu (
mode only)
Menu item
Submenu
Setting options
A
–
1
[Time Code]
[Mode]
[Preset], [Regen.]
[Rec Run], [Free Run]
[DF], [NDF]
1
[Run]
2
[DF/NDF]
[Setting]
[Set], [Reset]
[TC In/Out]
[24P TC/Sync]
[Rec Mode]
[Output Mode]
[Type]
[In], [Out]
[XF Legacy], [Normal]
[Internal], [External]
[Fixed], [Pulldown]
[Setting], [Time], [Date]
[User Bit]
1
2
Available during MXF mode only.
When the frame rate is a setting other than 29.97P, 59.94i or 59.94P, the time code is set to [NDF] and this setting cannot be changed.
[24P TC/Sync]: Determines the frequency for time code input and output and synchronization through the
GENLOCK terminal and SYNC OUT terminal (tri-level signal) when the frame rate is set to 23.98P or 24.00P.
[XF Legacy]: Synchronization mode compatible with Canon XF series camcorders. Synchronizes the time
code at a 30-frame signal and the signal from the GENLOCK terminal and SYNC OUT terminal at a 59.94i or
60.00i signal. The SYNC OUT terminal outputs a 59.94i or 60.00i signal.
[Normal]: Standard synchronization mode. Synchronizes the time code at a 24-frame signal and the signal
from the GENLOCK terminal and SYNC OUT terminal at a 23.98P or 24.00P signal. The SYNC OUT terminal
outputs a 23.98P/PsF or 24.00P/PsF signal.
[¤ User Bit Setup] menu (
mode only*)
Menu item
Setting options
A
[Output Mode]
[Fixed], [Pulldown]
* Not available in the [Photos] index screen or photo playback screen.
Menu Options
[w Other Functions] menu
Menu item
Submenu
Setting options
A
Ü
[Reset]
[All Settings]
[Cancel], [OK]
[Cancel], [OK]
[Cancel], [OK]
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
[Camera Settings]
[Assignable Buttons]
[Save To *]
–
–
175
1
Ü
Ü
Ü
[Transfer Menu//]
[Menu], [Menu+/]
[Load From *]
[Menu], [Menu+/]
[Time Zone]
List of world time zones.
[UTC-05:00 New York] or [UTC+01:00
Ü
Ü
2
Central Europe]
[Set Clock]
[Date/Time]
–
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
[Date Format]
[YMD], [YMD/24H], [MDY], [MDY/24H],
[DMY], [DMY/24H]
2
1
[WFM (LCD)]
[Setting]
[WFM], [VS], [Edge Mon.], [Off]
[WFM], [VS], [Off]
Ü
–
–
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
[Waveform Monitor]
[Gain]
[Line], [Line+Spot], [Field], [RGB], [YPbPr]
[1x], [2x]
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
[Vectorscope]
[Gain]
[Spot], [Normal]
[1x], [5x]
[Edge Monitor]
[Gain]
[Type 1], [Type 2]
[Off], 1 to 15 (12
–
[Language !]
[Deutschnglish], [Español], [Français],
[Ita, [Polski], [
[
], [
],
Ü
Ü
[
]
[Assign Button]
[1] to [15]
[1] to [9]
See footnote 3
Ü
–
–
Ü
–
1
[Tally Lamp]
[On], [Off]
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
–
[Media Access LED]
[On], [Off]
Ü
–
–
1
[Fan]
[On], [Automatic]
-1023 to +1023 (000)
[Entire Clip], [Last 4 sec]
[Cancel], [OK]
[Genlock Adjust.]
[Rec Review]
–
–
–
–
[Delete Last Clip]
–
4
5
[Clips]
[Copy All Clips]
[Cancel], [OK]
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
4
[Copy $ Clips]
[Cancel], [OK]
–
5
[Delete All Clips]
[Cancel], [OK]
–
4
[Delete All $ Marks]
[Cancel], [OK]
–
1
[Photo Numbering]
[Reset], [Continu.]
[Cancel], [OK]
Ü
–
Ü
Ü
6
[Delete All Photos]
[Add / File]
[To Clip]
[On], [Off]
Ü
–
[To Photo]
[On], [Off]
Menu Options
Menu item
[Custom Function]
Submenu
[Shockless WB]
Setting options
A
[On], [Off]
[Control Dial]
2 [Iris], [ISO/Gain], [Off]
3 [ISO/Gain], [Off]
176
[Control Dial Dir.]
[Grip Ctrl Dial Dir.]
[SELECT Dial Dir.]
[F. Assist. B&W]
[Magn. Add. Disp.]
[3D Rec Mode]
[Reverse], [Normal]
[Reverse], [Normal]
[Reverse], [Normal]
[Both], [Magnify], [Peaking], [Off]
[Peaking], [Edge Mon.], [Off]
[On], [Off]
Ü
–
[Scan Reverse Rec]
[Character Rec]
[Both], [Vertical], [Horizontal], [Off]
[On], [Off]
[Reset Hour Meter]
[Cancel], [OK]
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
–
7
[Wi-Fi Remote]
[Set Up New]
[Select]
For details refer to “WFT-E6 Wireless File
Transmitter - Guide for Canon Camcorders”
(PDF file).
–
[Edit]
[Camera Settings]
[CF A]
[Initialize Media]
[Firmware]
[Cancel], [OK]
Ü
Ü
[CF B]
–
[SD Card]
[Complete], [Quick]
–
Ü
Ü
Ü
–
1
2
3
Not available in the [Photos] index screen or photo playback sn.
The default value depends on the country/region or purchase.
Setting options for [Assign Button]: [(NONE)], [PEAKING][ZEBRA], [WFM], [EDGE MON.], [MAGN.], [Color Bars], [Markers], [LCD
Setup], [VF Setup], [LCD/VF B&W], [View Assist.], [LUT], [Resize MON. Output], [Resize MXF Output], [Onscreen Display], [Add
Shot Mark 1], [Add Shot Mark 2], [Add $ Mark], [Add % Mark], [Time Code], [Time Code Hold], [Headphone +], [Headphone -],
[Audio Output CH], [Audio Level], [Photo], [FUNC.], [FUNC. Shutter], [FUNC. ISO/Gain], [FUNC. WB], [S&F Frame Rate], [My
Menu], [Initialize Media], [LENS EXCHANGE], [User Setting (NONE)].
The default settings are as follows. [1]: [MAGN.], [2]: [PEAKING], [3]: [ZEBRA], [4]: [WFM], [5]: [LENS EXCHANGE], [6]: [LUT],
[7]: [MAGN.], [8]: [WFM], [9]: [EDGE MON.], [10] to [15]: [(NONE)].
Available in the clip index screen and [$ Mark] index screen only.
Available in the clip index screen only.
Available in the [Photos] index screen and photo playback screen only.
4
5
6
7
Only appears when the optional WFT-E6 Wireless File Transmitter is attached to the camera.
[Reset]: Reset various camera settings.
[All Settings]: Resets all the camera’s settings to default settings, except for the hour meter.
[Camera Settings]: Resets the white balance, iris (2 only), ISO speed, gain, shutter speed, [~ Camera
Setup] settings and custom picture settings to default settings.
[Assignable Buttons]: Resets the assignable buttons to default settings.
[Tally Lamp]: Allows you to set whether the tally lamp illuminates while recording.
[Media Access LED]: Allows you to set whether the CF card access indicators or the SD card access indicator
illuminates while the camera is accessing a CF card or SD card.
[Genlock Adjust.]: The phase difference between the external Genlock signal and the camera is initially set to 0.
This function allows you to adjust it within the range of approx. 0.4 H (-1023 to 1023). When setting to 1000 or
more or -1000 or less, set the first field to 10 or -10, respectively.
[Delete Last Clip]: Deletes the last MXF clip you recorded. This setting option will not appear if you turned the
camera off since recording the last clip.
[Reset Hour Meter]: The camera has two “hour meters” – the first keeps track of total operation time and the
second keeps track of operation time since the last time the second hour meter was reset with this function.
[Firmware]: You can verify the current version of the camera’s firmware. This menu option is usually unavailable.
Displaying the Status Screens
Displaying the Status Screens
You can use the status screens to check the camera’s various recording- and playback-related settings. You can
also output the status screens on an external monitor.
178
Operating modes:
1 Press the STATUS button.
• The status screen most recently displayed will appear
unless you turned off the camera or changed the operating
mode. In such case, the [Camera] status screen appears in
mode and the [Assign Button 1/2] status screen
appears in
mode.
2 Push the joystick up/down or use the SELECT dial to
scroll through the status screens.
3 When you are finished, press the STATUS button again
to exit the status screens.
• Alternatively, you can press the MENU or CUSTOM
PICTURE button. Doing so will exit the status screen and
open the respective menu.
,
Status screen
Description
A
1
[Camera]
Displays settings related to recording, such as ISO speed/gain, iris
1
and shutter speed increments, peripheral illumnation correction and
Ü
Ü
–
1
attached lens model information .
[Assign Button 1/2],
[Assign Button 2/2]
Allows you to verify the curent fun of each assignable button.
Ü
2
[Audio]
[Media]
Displays settings related to audio.
Ü
Ü
Ü
Ü
Displays information about the recording media.
[4K/2K/MXF 1/2],
[4K/2K/MXF 2/2]
Ü
–
–
Ü
–
Displays the settings for the video terminals and for MXF clips.
[Video]
[Metadata 1/2], [Metadata 2/2]
Displays the user memo and other metadata that will be recorded
with clips.
Ü
[Battery/Hour Meter]
Allows you to check the remaining battery time, battery life and how
long the camera has been in operation.
Ü
Ü
Ü
[/ Data 1/3], [/ Data 2/3],
Displays the settings for the custom picture file that will be
embedded into clips.
–
3
[/ Data 3/3]
[Wi-Fi Remote 1/4] to
[Wi-Fi Remote 4/4]
Displays settings related to the configuration of the optional WFT-E6
Wireless File Transmitter and the Wi-Fi network setup. For more
details, download the “WFT-E6 Wireless File Transmitter - Guide for
Canon Camcorders” (PDF file) from your local Web site and follow the
instructions to complete the necessary setup.
4
Ü
–
–
1
2 only.
2
3
4
Does not appear in the [Photos] index screen.
These screens appear only after a custom picture file has been selected.
These screens appear only when the optional WFT-E6 Wireless File Transmitter is attached to the camera and an active access
point has been activated with the [w Other Functions] > [Wi-Fi Remote] setting.
Displaying the Status Screens
[Audio] Status Screen
In
mode
180
1
2
8
9
3
4
5
6
7
10
In
mode
7
1
6
7
8
9
2
3
4
5
[Media] Status Screen
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
10
11
1
2
3
4
5
6
CF card A
CF card B
SD card
Total space on CF card A
Used space on CF card A
Available recording time on CF card A
7
8
9
Approximate used space on CF card A
Total space on SD card
Used space on SD card
10 Available number of shots on SD card
11 Approximate used space on SD card
NOTES
• Depending on the recording media, the total space displayed on the screen may differ from the nominal
capacity listed on the CF card or SD card.
Displaying the Status Screens
[4K/2K/MXF 1/2] Status Screen (
mode, 4K and 2K modes only)
1
2
3
4
181
5
6
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
[4K/2K/MXF 2/2] (
mode) / [Video] (
mode) Status Screen
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
HDMI OUT terminal status
HD/SD SDI terminal output status and scan mode
SYNC OUT terminal output status and scan
4
5
6
7
8
3
* Appears in
mode only.
[Metadata 1/2] Status Screen (
mode only)
1
2
3
4
5
1
2
3
Clip title
Camera operator
4
5
Filming location
Clip description
Displaying the Status Screens
[Metadata 2/2] Status Screen (
mode only)
1
2
3
182
1
2
Organization code
3
User code
[Battery/Hour Meter] Status Screen
1
2
3
4
5
1
2
3
Remaining recording time
Remaining battery level indicator
Battery life indicator
4
5
Operation time since using [Reset Hour Meter]
[/ Data 1/3] Status Screen (
mode only)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
Black gamma settings (level, range and point)
6
7
Skin detail settings (hue, chroma, area and
Selective NR settings (hue, chroma, area and
8
9
Displaying the Status Screens
[/ Data 2/3] Status Screen (
mode only)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
183
1
Sharpness settings (level, horizontal detail
frequency, horizontal/vertical detail balance, and
Sharpness settings (select, knee aperture gain
Level depend settings (level, slope and offset)
4
Coring settings (level, offset, curve and depth)
Color matrix settings (select, gain and phase)
5
6
2
3
7
[/ Data 3/3] Status Screen (
mode only)
1
2
3
4
5
7
8
6
1
2
3
Area A settings (phase, chroma, area and Y level)
5
6
Area B settings (phase, chroma, area and Y level)
Area B revision settings (level and phase)
4
Area A revision settings (level and phase)
7
8
Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting
If you have a problem with your camera, refer to this section. Consult your dealer or a Canon Service Center if
the problem persists.
184
Power source
The camera will not turn on or it turns off by itself.
- The battery pack is exhausted. Replace or charge the battery pack.
- Remove the battery pack and reattach it correctly.
Shortly after turning it on, the camera turns off on its own.
- You are using a DC coupler or a battery pack that is not compatible for use with this camera. Use a recommended
Cannot charge the battery pack.
- The temperature of the battery pack is outside the charging range. If the battery pack’s temperature is below 0 °C
(32 °F), warm it before charging it; if it is above 40 °C (104 °F), let the battery pack cool down before charging it.
- Charge the battery pack in temperatures between 0 °C and 40 °C (32 °F and 104 °F).
- The battery pack is faulty. Replace the battery pack.
The battery pack is exhausted extremely quickly even at normal temperatures.
- Check the [Battery/Hour Meter] status screen (A 182) to see whether the battery pack is at the end of its service life.
If so, buy a new battery pack.
Recording
The camera’s controls are not responsive/disabled
- The plug being connected into the GRIP terminal may not be correctly connected. Make sure the plug is firmly inserted
all the way into the GRIP terminal.
- When the Q switch is set to C, all buttons except for the START/STOP button are locked and cannot be
operated. Set the Q switch to CAMERA.
Pressing the START/STOP button will not start recording.
- Set [4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [3GI-SDI Output] to [On] to enable output from the 3G-SDI or MON. terminals.
- Set [4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [Rec Command] to [On] to enable the external recorder to be operated using the camera’s
START/STOP button.
- The camera is in lens exchange mode. Press the LENS EXCHANGE button to exit the mode.
The point where the START/STOP button was pressed does not match the beginning/end of the recording.
- There is a slight interval between pressing the START/STOP button and the actual start/end of recording. This is not a
malfunction.
The camera will not focus.
- The viewfinder is not adjusted. Use the dioptric adjustment dial to make the proper adjustment (A 38).
- The lens is dirty. Clean the lens with a soft lens-cleaning cloth.
When a subject flits across in front of the lens, the image appears slightly bent.
- This is a phenomenon typical of CMOS image sensors. When a subject crosses very quickly in front of the camera, the
image may seem slightly warped. This is not a malfunction.
Bright red, green or blue dots appear on the screen.
- The camera’s CMOS sensor is a delicate piece of precision engineering. Direct exposure of the sensor to ion rays or other
types of cosmic radiation may affect it and this may rarely appear as bright colored dots on the screen. This is the nature of
CMOS image sensors and does not represent a malfunction. Adjusting the black balance (A 50) may help solve the problem.
- The effects of the damage may be more noticeable when the camera is used in places subject to high temperatures,
when a high ISO speed or gain level is used and when slow shutter speeds are used.
Changing between recording (ÜREC) and record pause (STBY) takes longer than usual.
- When the CF card contains a large number of clips, some operations may take longer than usual. Save your clips
The camera cannot record to a CF card properly.
- This may occur as recordings are made and deleted over time. Save your clips (A 152) and initialize the CF card (A 47).
Troubleshooting
The camera becomes hot during use.
- The camera may become hot while shooting. This is not a malfunction.
- The camera’s internal temperature will rise if the cooling fan filter under the MON./3G-SDI terminal cover has clogged.
The built-in ND filter is stuck and does not change.
- The electronic motor that drives the ND filter may not be working correctly. As an emergency measure, you can
185
Playing Back MXF Clips
Cannot delete a clip.
Deleting clips takes longer than usual.
- When the CF card contains a large number of clips, some operations may take longer than usual. Save your clips
Cannot delete a photo.
- The LOCK switch on the SD card is set to prevent accidental erasure. Change the position of the LOCK switch.
Cannot copy clips.
- There is not enough available space on the CF card being copied to or the CF card already contains the maximum
Indicators and Onscreen Displays
ì appears in red on the screen.
- Battery pack is exhausted. Replace or charge the battery pack.
í appears on the screen.
- The camera cannot communicate with the battery pack attached so the remaining battery time cannot be displayed.
The tally lamp does not illuminate.
- Set [Other Functions] > [Tally Lamp] to [On].
The tally lamp flashes quickly.
(4 flashes per second)
- The battery pack is exhausted. Replace or charge the battery pack.
- There is not enough available space on the CF card. Delete some clips (A 136) to free some space or replace the CF
card.
- A system error has occurred. Turn off the camera and back on again. If this does not solve the problem, consult a
Canon Service Center.
The tally lamp flashes slowly.
(1 flash per second)
- The combined available space on both CF cards is low. Replace the CF card that is not being recorded onto.
2 or 3 appears in red on the screen.
- There is not enough available space on the CF card. Delete some clips (A 136) to free some space or replace the CF
card.
* appears in red on the screen.
- An SD card error occurred. Turn off the camera. Remove and reinsert the SD card. Initialize the SD card if the display
does not change back to normal.
- The SD card is full. Replace the SD card or delete some photos (A 162) to free some space on the SD card.
Even after stopping recording, the CF2/CF3 access indicator stays illuminated in red.
- The clip is being recorded. This is not a malfunction.
appears in yellow on the screen.
- The camera’s internal temperature has reached a predetermined level. You can continue using the camera.
Troubleshooting
appears in red on the screen.
- The camera’s internal temperature has risen while
appeared in yellow on the screen.
- If [Other Functions] > [Fan] is set to [On], turn off the camera and wait until the temperature has lowered.
- In mode, when [Other Functions] > [Fan] is set to [Automatic], the cooling fan will start automatically (
appears on the screen).
- The camera’s internal temperature will rise if the cooling fan filter under the MON./3G-SDI terminal cover has clogged.
186
appears on the screen.
- The camera and lens cannot communicate normally.
Picture and Sound
Screen displays turn on and off repeatedly.
- The battery pack is exhausted. Replace or charge the battery pack.
- Remove the battery pack and reattach it correctly.
Abnormal characters appear on the screen and the camera does not operate properly.
- Disconnect the power source and reconnect it after a short time. If the problem still persists, perform one of the
following actions.
• Disconnect the power source and press the RESET button. This resets all the camera’s settings to default values
except for custom picture settings and the hour meter.
• Use the [Other Functions] > [Reset] > [All Settings] function. This resets all the camera’s settings to default values
except for the hour meter.
Video noise appears on screen.
- Keep a distance between the camera and devices that emit stronelectromagnetic fields such as near powerful
magnets and motors, MRI machines or high-voltage power es.
Horizontal bands appear on the screen.
- This is a phenomenon typical of CMOS image sensors n recording under some types of fluorescent, mercury or
sodium lamps. To reduce the symptoms, set the shutter speed to 1/100 (A 68). This is not a malfunction.
Audio cannot be recorded.
- An external microphone connected to the XLR terminal requires phantom power. Set the XLR terminal switch to
- The camera’s MIC terminal is given priority over the XLR terminals. To record audio from the XLR terminals, be sure not
to connect any microphones to the MIC terminal.
Audio is recorded at an extremely low level.
- When using the XLR terminals: The AUDIO LEVEL switch is set to M, and the recording level is set too low. When using
the MIC terminal: [Audio Setup] > [Audio Input] > [MIC Mode] is set to [Manual] and the [MIC Level] setting is too
low. Check the audio level meter on the screen or rear panel and adjust the audio level correctly (A 94, 95).
Sound is distorted or is recorded at lower levels.
- When recording near loud sounds (such as fireworks, shows or concerts), sound may become distorted or it may not
be recorded at the actual levels. Activate the microphone attenuator (A 95, 96), or adjust the audio recording level
manually.
Recording Media and Accessories
Cannot insert the recording media.
- The CF card or SD card you are trying to insert is not facing the correct direction. Turn it over and insert it.
Cannot record on the CF card.
- The CF card is full or it already contains the maximum number of clips (999 clips). Delete some clips (A 136) to free
some space or replace the CF card.
Troubleshooting
Cannot record on the SD card.
- The LOCK switch on the SD card is set to prevent accidental erasure. Change the position of the LOCK switch.
- The folder and file numbers have reached their maximum value. Set the [Other Functions] > [Photo Numbering]
setting to [Reset] and insert a new SD card.
187
Recording to and playing back from a CF card is slow.
- This may occur as video is recorded/deleted over time. Save your clips (A 152) and initialize the CF card (A 47).
Recording to and playing back from an SD card is slow.
- This may occur as photos are recorded/deleted over time. Save your photos and initialize the SD card (A 47).
Connections with External Devices
Video is not recorded on an external recorder.
- Check the external recorder’s instruction manual to make sure that the external recorder is set to receive the signal
being output by the camera.
Video noise appears on a nearby TV screen.
- When using the camera in a room where a TV is located, keep a distance between the compact power adapter and the
power or antenna cables of the TV.
Playback looks fine on the camera but there is no image on the external monitor.
- The camera is not connected correctly to the external monitor. Make sure you are using the correct connection
- The video input on the external monitor is not set to the video teminal to which you connected the camera. Select the
correct video input.
The camera is connected using a commercially availabHDI cable, but there is no picture or sound from the
external monitor.
- Disconnect the HDMI cable and then restore thconnection or turn the camera off and then on again.
List of Messages
Refer to this section if a message appears on the screen. The messages in this section appear in alphabetical
order. For error messages related to the optional WFT-E6 Wireless File Transmitter refer to the Troubleshooting
section of the ‘WFT-E6 Wireless File Transmitter - Guide for Canon Camcorders’ (A 34).
Accessing CF A/CF B Do not remove
- You opened the CF card slot cover while the camera was accessing the CF card. Close the CF card slot cover.
Camera Q Lens communication error. Clean the lens’s contacts and reattach the lens.
- The camera cannot communicate with the lens. Remove the lens while making sure that dust does not accumulate on
the lens or enter the camera. Then, wipe the lens mount and lens contacts with a soft cloth.
Cannot acquire battery information
- Battery information can be displayed only for batteries bearing the Intelligent System mark.
Cannot communicate with the battery pack. Continue using this battery pack?
- You attached a battery pack that does not bear the Intelligent System mark.
- If you are using a battery pack that bears the Intelligent System mark, there may be a problem with the camera or
battery pack. Consult a Canon Service Center.
Cannot play back
- The file control information is corrupted or there was a decoder error. Turn off the camera and back on again. If this
does not solve the problem, consult a Canon Service Center.
• Corrupted file control information cannot be recovered. CF cards or clips with corrupt file control information cannot
be read by the supplied Canon XF Utility or plugins.
Troubleshooting
Cannot record
- Cannot record on a CF card. The file control information is corrupted or there was an encoder error. Turn off the
camera and back on again. Then, remove the CF card being used and reinsert it. Alternatively, replace the CF card. If
this does not solve the problem, consult a Canon Service Center.
• Corrupted file control information cannot be recovered. CF cards or clips with corrupt file control information cannot
be read by the supplied Canon XF Utility or plugins.
188
Cannot switch CF card slots
- The SLOT SELECT button was pressed while the camera is recording. Wait until recording is finished to change the
selected CF card slot.
CF A/CF B Buffer overflow. Recording was stopped.
- The data transfer rate was too high for the CF card in use and the recording was stopped. Use a recommended card
CF A/CF B Cannot restore
CF A/CF B error
- The CF card cannot be recognized or cannot be accessed. Check that the CF card is inserted correctly and not
malfunctioning.
CF A/CF B Management data is not supported and will be deleted
- This message may appear if you insert into the camera a CF card that was initialized by a Canon professional
camcorder. Check the contents of the CF card.
CF A/CF B Management file error Cannot record
- Cannot record because the camera cannot write to the file control information. This may occur if the files on the CF
• During double slot recording, both “CF A” and “CF B” will appear in the message.
CF A/CF B Media full
- If either “CF A” or “CF B” appears in the message: CF card or CF card B is full so recording will not start. Switch to
the CF card in the other CF card slot to record.
- If both “CF A” and “CF B” appear in the messageCF cA and CF card B are full. Delete some clips (A 136) to free
some space or replace a CF card.
CF A/CF B Media is almost full
- The amount of available space on CF card A and CF card B combined is low. Replace the CF card that is not selected.
CF A/CF B Media is not supported
- CF cards that are less than 512 MB or not UDMA-compatible cannot be used with the camera. Use a recommended
CF A/CF B Number of clips already at maximum
- The CF card selected for recording already contains the maximum number of clips (999 clips). Replace the CF card or
use the CF card in the other CF card slot.
- Because both CF cards reached the maximum number of clips, double slot recording is not available.
• During double slot recording, both “CF A” and “CF B” will appear in the message.
CF A/CF B Operation canceled.
- The file control information is corrupted or there was an encoder error. Turn off the camera and back on again. Then,
remove the CF card being used and reinsert it. Alternatively, replace the CF card. If this does not solve the problem,
consult a Canon Service Center.
• Corrupted file control information cannot be recovered. CF cards or clips with corrupt file control information cannot
be read by the supplied Canon XF Utility or plugins.
CF A/CF B Reached the recording limit for one clip. Recording was stopped.
- When recording a single clip for an extended period of time, the clip will be split into smaller video files every 2 GB (or
1 GB when recording in slow motion). This message will appear when the number of smaller video files reaches 99.
CF A/CF B Using a card that supports UDMA mode 4 or higher is recommended
- The CF card’s UDMA mode is lower than UDMA4. We recommend using a CF card that with a UDMA mode of at least
UDMA4.
CF AJCF B / CF BJCF A Switched
- This message appears when you use the SLOT SELECT button to switch the CF card slot in use or recording
continued from one CF card to the other.
CF AJCF B / CF BJCF A Will switch in a moment
- The CF card is almost full so recording will continue on the other CF card in approximately 1 minute.
Troubleshooting
CF card slot cover is open.
- The CF card slot cover was open when the camera was switched to or turned on in
mode. Close the cover.
Change the battery pack
- The battery pack is exhausted. Replace or charge the battery pack.
189
% / $ Mark Error
- Could not add a % mark or $ mark. If the message appears in
not work, add the mark in mode. If the message appears in
mode, try adding the mark again. If that does
mode, turn off the camera and then back
on. Then, try to add the mark again.
Check the data on CF A/CF B Initializing the card is also recommended
- The CF card cannot be used for any of the following reasons.
• A problem has occurred with the CF card.
• The camera cannot read the CF card’s data.
• The CF card was initialized using a computer.
• The CF card has been partitioned.
Check the SD card
- The SD card cannot be accessed. Check that the SD card is inserted correctly and not malfunctioning.
- Due to an SD card error, photos cannot be taken or viewed. Remove and then reinsert the SD card or use a different
SD card.
Data on CF A/CF B needs recovering Attempt to recover?
- If data on the CF card is corrupted, such as when the power suddenly turned off while recording, the data must be
recovered. When this message appears, select [Yes] and press SET.
Fan error
- The cooling fan may not be working properly. Consult a Canon Service Center.
File name error
- The folder and file numbers have reached their maximm vue. Set [Other Functions] > [Photo Numbering] to
Invalid operation
- The following operations cannot be performed.
• Adding a shot mark to a clip that already has a shot mark or to a clip in frame recording mode or interval recording mode.
• Adding an $ mark to clip that already has an $ mark or adding a % mark to a clip that already has a % mark.
• In
• Pressing the START/STOP button when there is no CF card in the camera during MXF mode.
No clips
mode, immediately reviewing a recording made in a special recording mode.
- There are no clips on the CF card to play back. Clips must be recorded (A 53) in order to play them back.
No photos
- There are no photos on the SD card to play back. Photos must be taken (A 159) in order to view them.
No Shot Marks
- This message appears if shot marks in a clip were deleted from the [Shot Mark] index screen. Press the INDEX button
to return to the clip index screen.
Number of Shot Marks at maximum
- The shot mark could not be added because the clip already contains 100 shot marks (" and # marks combined). You
Please open the MON./3G-SDI terminal cover
- The camera cannot enter 4K or 2K mode when the MON./3G-SDI terminal cover is closed. Open the cover.
Recorded at 24.00 Hz Check the data on CF A/CF B Initializing the card is also recommended.
- The CF card contains 24.00 Hz recordings. To record on this CF card, save your clips (A 152) and initialize the CF card
(A 47). To play back the recordings on the CF card, set [4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [System Frequency] to [24.00 Hz].
Recorded at 59.94 Hz/50.00 Hz Check the data on CF A/CF B Initializing the card is also recommended
- The CF card contains clips that were recorded using a system frequency other than the one currently used by the
camera. To record on this CF card, save your clips (A 152) and initialize the CF card (A 47). To play back the
recordings on the CF card, set [4K/2K/MXF Setup] > [System Frequency] to [59.94 Hz] or [50.00 Hz] as necessary, so
the camera matches the CF card.
SD card error
Troubleshooting
Shot Mark Error
- Could not add a shot mark. If the message appears in
mode, try adding the mark again. If that does not work,
add the mark in
mode after you finish recording. If the message appears in mode, turn off the camera
and then back on. Then, try to add the mark again.
System error
190
- Turn off the camera and back on again. If this does not solve the problem, there may be a malfunction with the camera.
Consult a Canon Service Center.
Temperature too high The fan will be activated
- The camera’s internal temperature has risen while the camera is in
to [Automatic]. Select [OK] to activate the cooling fan.
mode and [Other Functions] > [Fan] is set
This photo cannot be displayed
- You may not be able to display photos taken with other devices or image files created or edited on a computer.
Handling Precautions
Handling Precautions
Camera
Be sure to observe the following precautions to ensure maximum performance.
191
• Do not carry the camera by the LCD panel or monitor unit. Be careful when closing the LCD panel.
• Do not leave the camera in places subject to high temperatures (like the inside of a car parked under direct
sunlight), or high humidity.
• Because the camera’s temperature can rise significantly, do not hold the camera for long periods of time while
shooting.
• Do not use the camera near strong electromagnetic fields such as near powerful magnets and motors, MRI
machines or high-voltage power lines. Using the camera in such places may cause anomalies in the video or
audio or video noise to appear.
• Do not use or store the camera in dusty or sandy places. The camera is not waterproof – avoid also water,
mud or salt. If any of the above should get into the camera it may damage the camera and/or the lens. Consult
a Canon Service Center as soon as possible.
• Be careful to avoid dust and dirt particles accumulating on the lens or entering the camera. When you finish
using the camera, make sure to attach the body cap to the lens mount and the lens cap and dust cap to the
lens.
• Do not point the lens or viewfinder lens at the sun or other strong light sources. Do not leave the camera
pointed at a bright subject. Internal components may become damaged due to concentration of the light by
the lens. Be careful especially when using a tripod or shoulder strap. When you are not using the camera or
viewfinder, make sure to attach the lens cap to the lens and he viewfinder cap to the viewfinder.
• Be careful of heat generated by lighting equipment.
• Do not disassemble the camera. If the camera doot function properly, consult qualified service personnel.
• Do not touch the lens contacts on the lens mount. ty contacts may cause a poor
contact between the camera and the lens resulting in incorrect operation of the
camera. After removing the lens, make sure to attach the body cap to the lens mount
and the lens cap and dust cap to the lens.
• Handle the camera with care. Do not subject the camera to shocks or vibration as this
may cause damage. When using the shoulder strap, do not allow the camera to swing
and hit an object.
Long-term storage
If you do not intend to use the camera for a long time, store it in a place free of dust, in low humidity, and at
temperatures not higher than 30 °C (86 °F).
Battery Pack
DANGER!
Treat the battery pack with care.
• Keep it away from fire (or it might explode).
• Do not expose the battery pack to temperature higher than 60 °C (140 °F). Do not leave it near a heater or
inside a car in hot weather.
• Do not try to disassemble or modify it.
• Do not drop it or subject it to shocks.
• Do not get it wet.
• Dirty terminals may cause a poor contact between the battery pack and the camera. Wipe the terminals with a
soft cloth.
Handling Precautions
Long-term storage
• Store battery packs in a dry place at temperatures no higher than 30 °C (86 °F).
• To extend the battery life of the battery pack, discharge it completely before storing it.
• Charge and discharge all your battery packs fully at least once a year.
192
Always attach the battery terminal cover.
Do not allow any metal objects to touch the terminals (figure 1), as this can
cause a short circuit and damage the battery pack. Attach the terminal cover
whenever the battery pack is not being used (figure 2).
The battery terminal cover has a [ð]-shaped hole. This is useful when you
wish to differentiate between charged and uncharged battery packs. For
example, with charged battery packs, attach the terminal cover so that the
[ð]-shaped hole shows the colored label.
Figure 1
Figure 2
Terminal cover attached
Charged
Back side of the
battery pack
Uncharged
Remaining battery time
If the remaining battery time displayed is not correct, rgthe battery pack fully. Still, the correct time may not
be displayed if a fully charged battery pack is used couously in high temperatures or it is left unused for long
periods of time. Also, the correct remaining time manot be displayed, depending on the battery life. Use the
time shown on the screen as an approximation.
Using higher capacity batteries
You can use the optional BP-970G / BP-975 battery packs with this
camera. However, as the battery compartment cover cannot be closed
when using these higher capacity battery packs, you will need to remove
it beforehand. Note that removing the battery compartment cover will
render the camera more exposed to moisture, dust and foreign objects.
1 Slide down the BATT.OPEN switch and open the battery
compartment cover.
2 Push the latch at the bottom of battery compartment.
3 Gently pull out the battery compartment cover.
Regarding the use of non-Canon battery packs
• We recommend using genuine Canon battery packs bearing the Intelligent System
mark.
• If you attach to the camera battery packs that are not genuine Canon battery packs, the remaining battery
time will not be displayed.
Handling Precautions
Recording Media
• We recommend backing up the recordings on the recording media onto your computer. Data may be
corrupted or lost due to defects or exposure to static electricity. Canon shall not be liable for lost or corrupted
data.
193
• Do not touch or expose the terminals to dust or dirt.
• Do not use recording media in places subject to strong magnetic fields.
• Do not leave recording media in places subject to high humidity and high temperature.
• Do not disassemble, bend, drop, or subject recording media to shocks and do not expose them to water.
• Check the direction before inserting the recording media. Forcing recording media into the slot if it is not
correctly oriented may damage the recording media or the camera.
• Do not attach any labels or stickers on the recording media.
• SD cards: SD cards have a physical switch to prevent writing on the card so as to
avoid the accidental erasure of the card’s content. To write-protect the SD card,
set the switch to the LOCK position.
LOCK switch
Built-in Rechargeable Lithium Battery
The camera has a built-in rechargeable lithium battery to keep the date/time and other settings. The built-in
lithium battery is recharged while you use the camera; however, it will discharge completely if you do not use the
camera for about 3 months.
To recharge the built-in lithium battery: Connect the DC cable and compact power adapter to the camera and
use a household power outlet to power the camera for 2hours while it is turned off.
Disposal
When you delete data on the recording media, only the file allocation table is altered and stored data is not
physically erased. Take the necessary precautions when you dispose of the recording media, for example by
physically damaging it to prevent the leakage of private data.
If giving the recording media to another person, initialize it (using the [Complete] initialization option for SD cards,
(A 47)). Fill it up with unimportant recordings, and then initialize it again. This makes recovering the original
recordings very difficult.
Maintenance/Others
Maintenance/Others
Cleaning
Camera Body
194
• Use a soft, dry cloth to clean the camera body. Never use chemically treated cloths or volatile solvents such as
paint thinner.
Lens
• Remove any dust or dirt particles using a non-aerosol type blower brush.
• Use a clean, soft lens-cleaning cloth to gently wipe the lens using commercially available cleaning fluid for
eyeglasses. Never use tissue paper.
LCD Screen
• Clean the LCD screen using a clean, soft lens-cleaning cloth.
• Condensation may form on the surface of the screen when the temperature changes suddenly. Wipe it with a
soft dry cloth.
Viewfinder
Viewfinder
1 Slide the viewfinder unit’s LOCK/RELEASE screw to the RELEASE position and remove the
viewfinder unit by sliding it up.
2 Wipe away dirt with a cotton swab.
3 Reattach the viewfinder unit by sliding it back onto the camera and turn back the LOCK/RELEASE
screw to the LOCK position.
IMPORTANT
• Be careful not to scratch the glass and screen when cleaning them.
Maintenance/Others
Cooling fan
cover
Replacing the Cooling Fan Filter
You can replace the cooling fan filter, which is located under the
cover of the MON./3G-SDI terminals.
195
1 Remove the cooling fan cover.
• Hold the top and bottom of the center opening and remove the
cover.
2 Remove the filter.
3 Attach the new filter.
4 Reattach the cover.
• Hook the cover behind the lower tabs as shown in the
illustration and then hook the cover behind the upper tabs.
Cooling
fan filter
NOTES
• Filters can be reused by washing them in water or mild detergent.
Make sure filters are completely dry before attaching them to the
camera.
• Contact a Canon Service Center to purchase replacement filters.
Condensation
Moving the camera rapidly between hot and cold temerares may cause condensation (water droplets) to form
on its internal surfaces. Stop using the camera if cosation is detected. Continued use may damage the
camera.
Condensation may form in the following cases:
• When the camera is moved quickly from cold to warm places
• When the camera is left in a humid room
• When a cold room is heated rapidly
To avoid condensation
• Do not expose the camera to sudden or extreme changes in temperature.
• Remove the recording media and battery pack. Then, place the camera in an airtight plastic bag and let it
adjust gradually to temperature changes before removing it from the bag.
When condensation is detected
The camera automatically shuts off.
The precise time required for water droplets to evaporate will vary depending on the location and weather
conditions. As a general rule, wait for 2 hours before resuming use of the camera.
Maintenance/Others
Operating the ND Filter Manually
In the rare case that the internal electronic motor that drives the ND filter malfunctions, you can operate the ND
filter manually as an emergency measure.
196
1 Turn off the camera and remove the lens.
2 Unscrew the screw in the illustration and remove the cover.
3 Pressing lightly, use a Phillips head screwdriver to turn the
ND filter as necessary.
• You can check the position of the ND filter through the lens
mount.
4 Return the cover and tighten the screw.
Using the Camera Abroad
Power Sources
You can use the compact power adapter to operate the camera and
to charge battery packs in any country with power supply between
100 and 240 V AC, 50/60Hz. Consult a Canon Service Center for
information on plug adapters for overseas use.
Optional Accessories
Optional Accessories
The following optional accessories are compatible with this camera. The availability differs from area to area.
197
BP-950G, BP-955,
BP-970G, BP-975
Battery Pack
CA-940 Compact
Power Adapter
CA-930 Compact
Power Adapter*
CB-920 Car Battery
Adapter*
WFT-E6 Wireless File
Transmitter
TA-100 Tripod Adapter
SBR-1000 Shooting
Brace
TB-1 Tripod Adapter
Base**
* This accessory cannot be used to power this camera irectly; an only be used to charge the battery pack.
**For tripods with 0.95 cm (3/8 in.) screws.
For our customers in the USA: Call or visit your local retailer/dealer for genuine Canon video accessories. You
can also obtain genuine accessories for your Canon camera by calling: 1-800-828-4040, Canon U.S.A.
Information Center.
Use of genuine Canon accessories is recommended.
This product is designed to achieve excellent performance when used with genuine Canon accessories.
Canon shall not be liable for any damage to this product and/or accidents such as fire, etc., caused by the
malfunction of non-genuine Canon accessories (e.g., a leakage and/or explosion of a battery pack). Please
note that this warranty does not apply to repairs arising out of the malfunction of non-genuine Canon
accessories, although you may request such repairs on a chargeable basis.
Battery Packs
When you need extra battery packs, select from the following: BP-950G,
BP-955, BP-970G*, BP-975*
When you use battery packs bearing the Intelligent System mark, the camera
will communicate with the battery and display the remaining usage time
(accurate to 1 minute). You can only use and charge these battery packs with
cameras and chargers compatible with Intelligent System.
BP-955
BP-975
* The optional BP-970G / BP-975 Battery Pack were not originally designed for use
with this camera. Because of its size, you will not be able to close the battery
Optional Accessories
Charging Times
Use the supplied CG-940 Battery Charger to charge battery packs. The charging times given in the following
table are approximate and vary according to charging conditions and initial charge of the battery pack.
BP-950G
245 min.
BP-955
BP-970G
350 min.
BP-975
198
200 min.
295 min.
Recording and Playback Times
Recording and playback times given in the following tables are approximate and vary according to recording
mode and charging, recording or playback conditions. The effective usage time of the battery pack may
decrease when recording in cold surroundings, when using the brighter screen settings, etc. The typical
shooting times listed below are approximate times for shooting with repeated operations such as start/stop, and
power on/off. The optional WFT-E6 Wireless File Transmitter draws power from the camera to operate. Effective
usage times will decrease when it is attached and then Wi-Fi Remote is used to shoot.
2 EF lenses with lens contacts draw power from the camera to operate some functions. Effective usage
times may decrease depending on the lens used.
Approximate times when shooting in 4K mode
The following are the shooting times with the monitor unit attached (LCD screen and viewfinder on), output from
the 3G-SDI terminals, MON. terminals and HD/SD SDI terminal on, and when simultaneously recording an MXF
clip (50 Mbps, 1920x1080, 23.98P).
Recording mode/
Resolution
Frame rate
59.94P
Usage time
BP-950G
BP-955
BP-970G
BP-975
RAW / 4096x2160
Recording (maximum)
Recording (typical)
Recording (maximum)
Recording (typical)
Recording (maximum)
Recording (typical)
Recording (maximum)
Recording (typical)
Recording (maximum)
Recording (typical)
80
5
80
50
90
55
90
55
90
50
75
45
80
50
90
55
90
50
90
50
110
65
115
70
50.00P
25.00P
24.00P
23.98P
115
70
125
75
125
75
135
80
125
75
135
80
125
75
135
80
Approximate times when shooting in 2K mode
The following are the shooting times with the monitor unit attached (LCD screen and viewfinder on), output from
the 3G-SDI terminals, MON. terminals and HD/SD SDI terminal on, and when simultaneously recording an MXF
clip (50 Mbps, 1920x1080, 23.98P).
Recording mode/
Resolution
Frame rate
59.94P
Usage time
BP-950G
BP-955
BP-970G
BP-975
12-bit /
2048x1080
Recording (maximum)
Recording (typical)
Recording (maximum)
Recording (typical)
Recording (maximum)
Recording (typical)
Recording (maximum)
Recording (typical)
Recording (maximum)
Recording (typical)
90
50
90
55
90
55
85
50
90
55
90
50
90
55
90
55
85
50
90
55
125
75
135
80
50.00P
24.00P
59.94P
50.00P
125
75
135
80
10-bit /
2048x1080
125
75
135
80
10-bit /
2048x1080
120
70
130
75
125
75
135
80
Optional Accessories
Approximate times for MXF mode
The following are the shooting and playback times with the monitor unit attached (LCD screen and viewfinder on)
and output from the HD/SD SDI terminal on.
Bit rate/Resolution
Frame rate
24.00P
Usage time
Recording (maximum)
Recording (typical)
BP-950G
155
BP-955
155
BP-970G
220
BP-975
235
199
50 Mbps /
1920x1080
95
95
135
140
CB-920 Car Battery Adapter
Use the car battery adapter to charge battery packs on the go. The car
battery adapter plugs into your car’s cigarette lighter socket and runs off a
12-24 V DC negative ground battery.
TA-100 Tripod Adapter
The TA-100 allows you to quickly mount/unmount the
camera on/from a tripod.
SBR-1000 Shooting Brae
Using the SBR-100r additional support of the camera with the neck
strap will signifily ghten the load of the camera’s weight while shooting.
This mark identifies genuine Canon video accessories. When you use Canon video equipment, we
recommend Canon-brand accessories or products bearing the same mark.
Specifications
Specifications
C500 / C500 PL
System
200
• Video Configuration for 4K and 2K Modes
4K mode:
Mode: RAW, HRAW (both 10-bit)
Resolution: 4096x2160, 3840x2160, 4096x1080, 3840x1080
1
Frame rate : 59.94P, 29.97P, 23.98P, 50.00P, 25.00P, 24.00P
2K mode:
Mode: RGB, 4:4:4, 12-bit; RGB, 4:4:4, 10-bit; YCC, 4:2:2, 10-bit
Resolution: 2048x1080, 1920x1080
1
Frame rate : 59.94P, 29.97P, 23.98P, 50.00P, 25.00P, 24.00P
Available frame rates depend on the resolution and recording mode settings.
1
• Recording System
Movies: Video compression: MPEG-2 Long GOP;
Audio compression: Linear PCM, 16 bits, 48 kHz, 2 channels
File type: MXF
Photos: DCF (Design rule for Camera File system), compatible with Exif Ver. 2.3, JPEG compression
• Video Configuration (MXF recording/playback)
50 Mbps (CBR, 4:2:2, 422P@HL)
1920x1080: 59.94i, 50.00i, 29.97P, 25.00P, 24.00P, 23.98P
1280x720: 59.94P, 50.00P, 29.97P, 25.00P, 24.00P, 23.98P
35 Mbps (VBR, 4:2:0, MP@HL)
1920x1080: 59.94i, 50.00i, 29.97P, 25.00.98P
1280x720: 59.94P, 50.00P, 29.97P, 25.00P, 23.98P
25 Mbps (CBR, 4:2:0, MP@H14)
1440x1080: 59.94i, 50.00i, 29.97P, 25.00P, 23.98P
• Recording Media (not included)
Movies: CompactFlash (CF) Card Type I (two slots)
2
Photos: SD or SDHC (SD High Capacity) memory card
2
Custom picture files, camera settings and user memo files can be saved on and read from the memory card as well.
3
• Maximum Recording Time
16 GB CF Card
50 Mbps: 40 min., 35 Mbps: 55 min., 25 Mbps: 80 min.
64 GB CF Card
50 Mbps: 160 min., 35 Mbps: 225 min., 25 Mbps: 310 min.
Approximate figures based on continuous recording.
3
• Image Sensor: Super-35mm-equivalent CMOS sensor, approx. 8,850,000 effective pixels (4096x2160)
• Viewfinder: 1.3 cm (0.52 in.), approx. 1,555,000 dots, 100% coverage
• Lens Mount
2 Canon EF mount compatible with Canon EF lenses (including EF-S lenses)
3 PL Lens mount without data interface terminals
Lens multiplication factor (for 35mm equivalent focal length):
Approx. 1.46 (when the horizontal resolution is 4096 or 2048)
Approx. 1.53 (when the horizontal resolution is 3840 or 1920)
• ND Filter: Built-in (Off, 2, 4 or 6 stops), motor operated
• White Balance
Custom white balance (two sets, A and B), color temperature setting (2,000K to 15,000K); two preset settings
(daylight, 5,400 K and incandescent lamp, 3,200 K) that can be further fine-tuned
Specifications
• 2 Iris: 1/2-stop increments, 1/3-stop increments, fine-tuning
• ISO Speed
1-stop increments: ISO 320, ISO 400 to ISO 12800, ISO 20000
1/3-stop increments: ISO 320 to ISO 20000
201
• Gain: -6 dB to 30 dB (3-dB increments), 0 dB to 24 dB (fine-tuning in 0.5-dB increments)
• Shutter Speed
Speed (1/3-stop increments, 1/4-stop increments), angle, clear scan, slow, off
4
• 2 Lens Peripheral Illumination Correction: Available for Canon EF lenses
4
Some Canon EF lenses are not compatible with peripheral illumination correction.
• Sensor Sensitivity (MXF mode, ISO 640 (0 dB), 2000 lux, 89.9% reflection)
59.94 Hz mode: F9 (1920x1080 at 59.94i) 50.00 Hz mode: F10 (1920x1080 at 50.00i)
• S/N Ratio (MXF mode, ISO 850, using Canon Log gamma)
54 dB (typical, 1920x1080, 59.94 Hz mode at 29.97P / 50.00 Hz mode at 25.00P)
• Subject Illumination (MXF mode, 24 dB, with a f/1.2 lens)
59.94 Hz mode: 0.30 lux (29.97P, shutter speed 1/30)
50.00 Hz mode: 0.25 lux (25.00P, shutter speed 1/25)
• Size of Photos
1920x1080 pixels, 1280x720 pixels (only when capturing a photo from a clip)
Terminals
• 3G-SDI Terminals 1 and 2
BNC jack, output only, 0.8 Vp-p / 75 Ω, unbalanc2.7 Gbps
SMPTE 424M, SMPTE ST 425-1
Video:
Resolution: 4096x2160, 3840x2160, 4096x1080, 3840x1080
Mode: RAW; RGB, 4:4:4, 12-bit; RGB, 4:4:4, 10-bit; YCC, 4:2:2, 10-bit
1
Frame rate : 59.94P, 29.97P, 23.98P, 50.00P, 25.00P, 24.00P
Embedded audio, time code (VITC/LTC)
1
Available frame rates depend on the resolution and recording mode settings.
• MON. Terminals 1 and 2
BNC jack, output only, 0.8 Vp-p / 75 Ω, unbalanced, 1.485 Gbps
SMPTE ST 292-1
Video:
Resolution: 2048x1080, 1920x1080
Mode: YCC, 4:2:2, 10-bit
Frame rate : 59.94i, 29.97P/PsF, 23.98P/PsF, 50.00i, 25.00P/PsF, 24.00P/PsF
2
3
Embedded audio, time code (VITC/LTC), assistance displays (magnification, peaking, zebra pattern,
onscreen markers)
2
3
Available frame rates depend on the resolution and recording mode settings.
Magnification is available for the output from both MON. 1 and MON. 2 terminals. Other assistance displays are available for
the output from the MON. 1 terminal only.
• HD/SD SDI Terminal
BNC jack, output only, 0.8 Vp-p / 75 Ω, unbalanced, 1.485 Gbps
HD-SDI:
SMPTE 292
Video: Resolution: 1920x1080, 1280x720
4
Frame rate : 59.94i, 29.97 (P/PsF), 23.98 (P/PsF), 50.00i, 25.00 (P/PsF),
24.00 (P/PsF), 59.94P, 50.00P
SMPTE 259M
SD-SDI:
Video: Resolution: 640x480, 768x576
Frame rate: 59.94i, 50.00i
Embedded audio, time code (VITC/LTC)
4
Available frame rates depend on the resolution and recording mode settings.
Specifications
• HDMI OUT Terminal
HDMI connector, output only
• SYNC OUT Terminal
BNC jack, output only, 1 Vp-p / 75 Ω
Output signal: HD component video luminance signal (HD-Y), HD analog tri-level signal, Analog blackburst
signal, SD composite video
202
• MIC Terminal
∅ 3.5 mm stereo mini-jack, -72 dBV (manual volume center, full scale -18 dB) / 600 Ω
Microphone attenuator: 20 dB
• × (Headphone) Terminal
∅ 3.5 mm stereo mini-jack, -G to -12 dBV (16 Ω load, volume range Min to Max) / 50 Ω or less
• GENLOCK Terminal
BNC jack, input only: 1 Vp-p / 75 Ω
• TIME CODE Terminal
BNC jack, input/output
Input: 0.5 Vp-p to 18 Vp-p / 10 kΩ
Output: 1 Vp-p / 75 Ω
• REMOTE Terminal
∅ 2.5 mm stereo mini-jack
• WFT Terminal
Proprietary connector for the optional WFT-E6 Wireless File Transmitter
• GRIP Terminal
Same as the grip unit connection terminal on the C/ C300 PL camcorder
Power/Others
• Power Supply (rated)
7.4 V DC (battery pack), 8.4 V DC (DC IN)
• Power consumption (For each mode, viewfinder/LCD screen normal brightness, HD/SD SDI output on.
For 4K and 2K modes, MON. and 3G-SDI output on, simultaneous MXF recording at 50 Mbps.)
During 4K mode, RAW, 4096x2160:
During 2K mode, RGB444, 2048x1080:
59.94P: 23.9 W, 50.00P: 22.9 W
59.94P: 20.9 W, 50.00P: 20.9 W
During MXF mode, 50 Mbps 1920x1080, 24.00P: 12.4 W
Maximum rated power consumption: 33.8 W
• Operating Temperature
0 – 40 °C (32 – 104 °F)
• Dimensions (W x H x D)*
Camera unit only:
2 160 x 179 x 171 mm (6.3 x 7.0 x 6.7 in.) 3 160 x 179 x 177 mm (6.3 x 7.0 x 7.0 in.)
Configuration with monitor unit:
185 x 249 x 187 mm (7.3 x 9.8 x 7.4 in.)
Configuration with handle unit and monitor unit:
185 x 284 x 301 mm (7.3 x 11.2 x 11.9 in.)
* All dimensions are approximate.
• Weight **
Camera unit only:
2 1820 g (4.0 lb.)
Camera with monitor unit, BP-955 battery pack and two CF cards:
2 2705 g (6.0 lb.) 3 2815 g (6.2 lb.)
3 1930 g (4.3 lb.)
Specifications
Camera with monitor unit, handle unit, BP-955 battery pack and two CF cards:
2 2885 g (6.4 lb.)
**All weights are approximate.
3 2995 g (6.6 lb.)
203
Modular Units
Monitor Unit
Modular unit can be rotated 270º on its axis; includes the LCD panel, recording and playback controls, XLR
terminals and related audio controls.
• LCD Panel: Articulated panel, 270º vertical rotation, 180º lateral rotation
• LCD Screen: 10.1 cm (4.0 in.), wide, color, approx. 1,230,000 dots, 100% coverage
• CH1, CH2 Terminals
XLR jack (pin1: shield, pin2: hot, pin3: cold), 2 sets
Sensitivity
MIC setting: -60 dBu (manual volume center, full scale -18 dB) / 600 Ω
LINE setting: 4 dBu (manual volume center, full scale -18 dB) / 10 kΩ
Microphone attenuator: 20 dB
• Weight: Approx. 645 g (1.4 lb.)
Handle Unit
Modular unit includes a cold accessory shoe and socket 0.64 cm (1/4 in.) screws for other accessories.
• Weight: Approx. 180 g (6.3 oz.)
CA-940 Compact Power Adapter
• Power Supply: 100 – 240 V AC, 50/60 Hz
• Rated Output / Consumption
8.4 V DC, 4.8 A / 0.85 A (100 V) - 0.47 (240 V)
• Operating Temperature: 0 – 40 °C (32 – 104 °F)
• Dimensions (W x H x D): Approx. 103 x 51 x 139 mm (4.1 x 2.0 x 5.5 in.)
• Weight: 395 g (13.9 oz.)
CG-940 Battery Charger
• Power Supply: 100 – 240 V AC, 50/60 Hz
• Rated Output / Consumption
8.4 V DC, 1.5/2.0 A / 100 - 240 V AC, 24W
• Operating Temperature: 0 – 40 °C (32 – 104 °F)
• Dimensions (W x H x D): 85 x 51 x 110 mm (3.3 x 2.0 x 4.3 in.)
• Weight: Approx. 240 g (8.5 oz.)
Specifications
BP-955 Battery Pack
• Battery Type
Rechargeable lithium ion battery, compatible with Intelligent System
204
• Rated Voltage
7.4 V DC
• Operating Temperature: 0 – 40 °C (32 – 104 °F)
• Battery Capacity
Typical: 5,200 mAh
Minimum: 37 Wh / 4,900 mAh
• Dimensions (W x H x D): 38.2 x 43.5 x 70.5 mm (1.5 x 1.7 x 2.8 in.)
• Weight: 220 g (7.8 oz)
Weight and dimensions are approximate. Errors and omissions excepted.
The information in this manual is verified as of September 2012. Subject to change without notice.
206
Photos
J
Playback
K
L
R
Recording
M
S
N
O
P
*2 only **3 only
207
T
W
X
U
Y
Z
V
USA
CANON CINEMA EOS LIMITED WARRANTY FOR PRODUCTS PURCHASED IN THE UNITED
STATES
The limited warranty set forth below is given by Canon U.S.A., Inc. (‘Canon USA’) with respect to (a) the Canon Cinema EOS Product, and (b) the accessories
for the Canon Cinema EOS Product (if any), packaged with this limited warranty (collectively the “Products”)* and purchased in the United States. This limited
warranty is only effective upon presentation of your Bill of Sale or other proof of purchase. The Products are warranted to the original end-user purchaser,
when delivered in new condition in its original container, under normal use against defective materials or workmanship as follows: Parts: At Canon USA’s
option, defective parts will be exchanged for new parts or comparable rebuilt parts for a period of ONE YEAR from the date of original purchase. Labor: For a
period of ONE YEAR from the date of original purchase, labor will be provided free of charge by Canon USA’s factory service centers or designated service
facilities located in the United States. When returning Products under this warranty, you must pre-pay the shipping charges, and you must enclose a copy of
the Bill of Sale or other proof of purchase with a complete explanation of the problem. During the ONE-YEAR warranty period, repairs will be made and the
Products will be return-shipped to you free of charge. For repairs after the warranty period is over, you will be given an estimate of the cost of repair and an
opportunity to approve or disapprove of the repair expense before it is incurred. If you approve, repairs will be made and the Products will be returned to you
at your risk and expense. If you disapprove, we will return-ship the Products to you at no charge to you to an address within the United States.
208
This limited warranty only applies if the Products are used in conjunction with compatible computer equipment and compatible software, as
to which items Canon USA will have no responsibility. Canon USA shall have no responsibility under this limited warranty for use of the
Products in conjunction with incompatible peripheral equipment and/or incompatible software. Non-Canon brand peripheral equipment and
software which may be distributed with, or factory loaded on, the Products, are sold ‘AS IS’ without warranty of any kind by Canon USA,
including any implied warranty regarding merchantability or fitness for a particular purpose. The sole warranty with respect to such non-
Canon brand items is given by the manufacturer or producer thereof.
* Except for the battery pack packaged with the Products, which carries a separate ninety (90) day limited warranty.
In order to obtain warranty service, please contact the authorized Canon retail dealer from whom you purchased the Products or contact the CANON
INFORMATION CENTER AT 855-CINE-EOS (855-246-3367) or on the internet at pro.usa.canon.com/support. You will be directed to the nearest service
facility for your Products.
This Limited Warranty covers all defects encountered in normal use of toduts and does not apply in the following cases:
A. Loss or damage to the Products due to abuse, mishandlingaccident, improper maintenance, use of non-Canon accessories or failure to follow
operating, maintenance or environmental instructions prescribed in Canon USA’s user’s manual;
B. If the Products are defective as a result of leaking batteries, sand, dirt or water damage;
C. If defects or damages are caused by the use of parts or supplies (other than those sold by Canon USA) that cause damage to the Products or that
cause abnormally frequent service calls or service problems;
D. If defects or damages are caused by service other than Canon USA’s factory service centers or authorized service facilities;
E. Any internal modification to product hardware or firmware;
F. Any applicable fee for Maintenance of the Products;
G. If the Product has had its serial number or dating altered or removed.
This Limited Warranty does not apply to Products purchased outside the United States. This Limited Warranty does not apply to accessories or
consumables not originally packaged with the Product. Please retain this warranty card and your Bill of Sale as a permanent record of your purchase. This
card ensures that you are contacted promptly should there be a safety inspection, modification or Product recall under applicable laws or regulations.
NO IMPLIED WARRANTY, INCLUDING MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE APPLIES TO THE PRODUCTS AFTER THE
APPLICABLE PERIOD OF EXPRESS WARRANTY OR GUARANTY (EXCEPT AS MENTIONED ABOVE) GIVEN BY ANY PERSON, FIRM OR CORPORATION
WITH RESPECT TO THE PRODUCTS SHALL BIND CANON USA (SOME STATES DO NOT ALLOW LIMITATIONS ON HOW LONG AN IMPLIED
WARRANTY LASTS, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATION OR EXCLUSION MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU). CANON USA SHALL NOT BE LIABLE FOR LOSS OF
REVENUES OR PROFITS, EXPENSE FOR SUBSTITUTE PRODUCTS OR SERVICE, STORAGE CHARGES, LOSS OR CORRUPTION OF DATA, INCLUDING
WITHOUT LIMITATION, LOSS OR CORRUPTION OF DATA STORED ON THE PRODUCTS’ HARD DRIVE, OR ANY OTHER SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES CAUSED BY THE USE, MISUSE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PRODUCTS, REGARDLESS OF THE LEGAL THEORY ON
WHICH THE CLAIM IS BASED, AND EVEN IF CANON USA HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. NOR SHALL RECOVERY
OF ANY KIND AGAINST CANON USA BE GREATER THAN THE PURCHASE PRICE OF THE PRODUCTS SOLD BY CANON USA AND CAUSING THE
ALLEGED DAMAGE. WITHOUT LIMITING THE FOREGOING, YOU ASSUME ALL RISK AND LIABILITY FOR LOSS, DAMAGE OR INJURY TO YOU AND
YOUR PROPERTY AND TO OTHERS AND THEIR PROPERTY ARISING OUT OF USE, MISUSE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PRODUCTS NOT CAUSED
DIRECTLY BY THE NEGLIGENCE OF CANON USA (SOME STATES DO NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATION MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU).THIS LIMITED WARRANTY SHALL NOT EXTEND TO ANYONE
OTHER THAN THE ORIGINAL PURCHASER OF THE PRODUCTS OR THE PERSON FOR WHOM IT WAS PURCHASED AS A GIFT.
This warranty gives you specific legal rights, and you may also have other rights which vary from state to state.
CANON U.S.A., INC
CANADA
CANON CINEMA EOS LIMITED WARRANTY FOR PRODUCTS PURCHASED IN CANADA
The limited warranty set forth below is given by Canon Canada Inc. (‘Canon Canada’) with respect to (a) the Canon Cinema EOS product, and (b) the
accessories for the Canon Cinema EOS Product (if any), packaged with this limited warranty (collectively the “Products”)* and purchased in Canada. This
limited warranty is only effective upon presentation of your Bill of Sale or other proof of purchase. The Products are warranted to the original end-user
purchaser, when delivered in new condition in its original container, under normal use against defective materials or workmanship as follows: Parts: At
Canon Canada’s option, defective parts will be exchanged for new parts or comparable rebuilt parts for a period of ONE YEAR from the date of original
purchase. Labor: For a period of ONE YEAR from the date of original purchase, labor will be provided free of charge by Canon Canada’s factory service
center or designated service facilities located in Canada. When returning Products under this warranty, you must pre-pay the shipping charges, and you
must enclose a copy of the Bill of Sale or other proof of purchase with a complete explanation of the problem. During the ONE-YEAR warranty period,
repairs will be made and the Products will be return-shipped to you free of charge. For repairs after the warranty period is over, you will be given an
estimate of the cost of repair and an opportunity to approve or disapprove of the repair expense before it is incurred. If you approve, repairs will be made
and the Products will be returned to you at your risk and expense. If you disapprove, we will return-ship the Products to you at no charge to you to an
address within Canada.
209
This limited warranty only applies if the Products are used in conjunction with compatible computer equipment and compatible software, as to
which items Canon Canada will have no responsibility. Canon Canada shall have no responsibility under this limited warranty for use of the
Products in conjunction with incompatible peripheral equipment and/or incompatible software. Non-Canon brand peripheral equipment and
software which may be distributed with, or factory loaded on, the Products, are sold ‘AS IS’ without warranty of any kind by Canon Canada,
including any implied warranty or condition regarding merchantability or fitness for a particular purpose. The sole warranty with respect to such
non-Canon brand items is given by the manufacturer or producer thereof.
* Except for the battery pack packaged with the Products, which carries a separate ninety (90) day limited warranty.
In order to obtain warranty service, please contact the authorized Canon retail dealer from whom you purchased the Products or contact the CANON
PROFESSIONAL SERVICE CENTRE 1-800-667-2666 or on the internet at www.canon.ca/pro. You will be directed to the nearest service facility for your
Products.
This Limited Warranty covers all defects encountered in normal use of the Prts and does not apply in the following cases:
A. Loss or damage to the Products due to abuse, mishandling, accmproper maintenance, use of non-Canon accessories or failure to follow
operating, maintenance or environmental instructions precribed in non Canada’s user’s manual;
B. If the Products are defective as a result of leaking batteries, sand, dirt or water damage;
C. If defects or damages are caused by the use of parts or supplies (other than those sold by Canon Canada) that cause damage to the Products or
that cause abnormally frequent service calls or service problems;
D. If defects or damages are caused by service other than Canon Canada’s factory service centers or authorized service facilities;
E. Any internal modification to product hardware or firmware;
F. Any applicable fee for Maintenance of the Products;
G. If the Product has had its serial number or dating altered or removed.
This Limited Warranty does not apply to Products purchased outside Canada. This Limited Warranty does not apply to accessories or consumables not
originally packaged with the Product. Please retain this warranty card and your Bill of Sale as a permanent record of your purchase. This card ensures
that you are contacted promptly should there be a safety inspection, modification or Product recall under applicable laws or regulations.
NO IMPLIED WARRANTY OR CONDITION, INCLUDING MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE APPLIES TO THE
PRODUCTS AFTER THE APPLICABLE PERIOD OF EXPRESS WARRANTY OR GUARANTY (EXCEPT AS MENTIONED ABOVE) GIVEN BY ANY PERSON,
FIRM OR CORPORATION WITH RESPECT TO THE PRODUCTS SHALL BIND CANON CANADA (SOME PROVINCES DO NOT ALLOW LIMITATIONS ON
HOW LONG AN IMPLIED WARRANTY OR CONDITION LASTS, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATION OR EXCLUSION MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU). CANON
CANADA SHALL NOT BE LIABLE FOR LOSS OF REVENUES OR PROFITS, EXPENSE FOR SUBSTITUTE PRODUCTS OR SERVICE, STORAGE
CHARGES, LOSS OR CORRUPTION OF DATA, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION, LOSS OR CORRUPTION OF DATA STORED ON THE PRODUCTS’
HARD DRIVE, OR ANY OTHER SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES CAUSED BY THE USE, MISUSE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
PRODUCTS, REGARDLESS OF THE LEGAL THEORY ON WHICH THE CLAIM IS BASED, AND EVEN IF CANON CANADA HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. NOR SHALL RECOVERY OF ANY KIND AGAINST CANON CANADA BE GREATER THAN THE PURCHASE PRICE OF
THE PRODUCTS SOLD BY CANON CANADA AND CAUSING THE ALLEGED DAMAGE. WITHOUT LIMITING THE FOREGOING, YOU ASSUME ALL RISK
AND LIABILITY FOR LOSS, DAMAGE OR INJURY TO YOU AND YOUR PROPERTY AND TO OTHERS AND THEIR PROPERTY ARISING OUT OF USE,
MISUSE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PRODUCTS NOT CAUSED DIRECTLY BY THE NEGLIGENCE OF CANON CANADA (SOME PROVINCES DO NOT
ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATION MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU).
THIS LIMITED WARRANTY SHALL NOT EXTEND TO ANYONE OTHER THAN THE ORIGINAL PURCHASER OF THE PRODUCTS OR THE PERSON FOR
WHOM IT WAS PURCHASED AS A GIFT.
This warranty gives you specific legal rights, and you may also have other rights which vary from province to province.
CANON CANADA INC.
Canon Inc.
30-2, Shimomaruko 3-chome, Ohta-ku, Tokyo 146-8501, Japan
ASIA and HONG KONG, S.A.R.
NEW ZEALAND www.canon.co.nz
Canon New Zealand Ltd
0800-222-666 (within New Zealand only)
(64) 09-489-0300
Canon Hongkong Company Ltd
19/F, The Metropolis Tower, 10 Metropolis Drive,
Hunghom, Kowloon, Hong Kong
+852 3191 2333,
+852 2428 3963
SINGAPORE
AUSTRALIA www.canon.com.au
Canon Australia Pty Ltd
13-13-83 (within Australia only)
(61) 02-9805-2555
Canon Singapore Pte. Ltd
1 HarbourFront Avenue, #04-01 Keppel Bay Tower,
Singapore 098632
(65) 6799 8888,
(65) 6799 8882
CANADA
UNITED KINGDOM
CANON CANADA INC.
http://www.canon.ca/pro
Canon UK Ltd
CCI Service Centre, Unit 130, Centennial Park,
Borehamwood, Hertfordshire, WD6 3SE
0844-369-0100
❖
Professional Product Support / Soutien des
produits professionnels
(800) 667-2666
USA
CENTRO Y SURAMÉRICA
CANON LATIN AMERICA, INC.
http://www.cla.canon.com
CANON U.S.A., INC.
http://pro.usa.canon.com
http://pro.usa.canon.com/support
(855) CINE-EOS (855-246-3367)
(USA only)
EUROPE www.canon-europa.com
Canon Europa N.V.
Bovenkerkerweg 59-61,
1185 XB Amstelveen, The Netherlands
MÉXICO
CANON MEXICANA, S DE RL DE CV
http://www.canon.com.mx
52 (55) 5249-4905
Visit your local Canon Web site to download the latest version of this Instruction Manual.
0168W565
© CANON INC. 2012
PUB. DIE-0426-000
|
Audiovox P 942WESP User Manual
BlueAnt Wireless Bluetooth SUPERTOOTH 3 User Manual
Bushnell Binoculars 26 0200 User Manual
Cannon HG20 User Manual
Canon UC V30 User Manual
Canon V 75 Hi User Manual
Carcomm i Mate Sp5 User Manual
Crown Boiler CWI345 User Manual
Cuisinart DLC 2007N User Manual
Fisher VPC C4GX User Manual